Fostex Musical Instrument VR800 User Manual

8288 429 000  
Owner’s Manual  
Model  
Digital Multitrack Recorder  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
IN  
OUT  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
STOP  
RECORD  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Table of Contents)  
Table of Contents  
Rehearsing manual punch in/out recording.............40  
Manual punch in/out Take............................................41  
Undo/redo manual punch in/out recording.............42  
Introduction.............................................................................5  
Main features...........................................................................5  
Precautions..................................................................................6  
Recording to a Metronome Sound.......................................43  
DigitalRecording......................................................................45  
Note on repair..........................................................................6  
About copyrights....................................................................6  
About damage.........................................................................6  
Digital recording from an external digital device..........45  
Digital recording to an external device............................46  
Names and Functions...............................................................7  
Storing a Locate Point (Edit Point)........................................48  
Top panel..................................................................................8  
Rear panel..............................................................................14  
Side panel...............................................................................15  
Display section...................................................................16  
Display when the power is turned on...........................16  
Preset display.....................................................................16  
Display examples for time base selected via  
Storing and editing the locate points  
to the memory keys .................................................49  
Storing in real-time...........................................................49  
Editing and storing locate data......................................50  
Editing and storing data..................................................50  
Storing and editing LOCATE key.......................................51  
Storing in real-time...........................................................51  
Editing and storing locate data......................................52  
Edit and re-store data that is already stored...............53  
the TIME BASE SEL key..........................................17  
Selecting time base using the DISP SEL key.................17  
The REMAIN display.........................................................18  
Warningmessage..............................................................19  
LocateFunction........................................................................54  
BeforeStarting..........................................................................20  
Direct Locate.......................................................................54  
Auto Play............................................................................55  
Auto Return........................................................................55  
Auto Repeat........................................................................56  
Time Base.............................................................................20  
Recording method and REMAIN indicator...................21  
Managing songs by Program Change function............22  
Real tracks and Additional tracks.....................................23  
Input monitoring and playback monitoring................24  
Audio file and event.............................................................25  
Cue&ReviewFunction...........................................................57  
Cue & Review function using  
the REWIND and F FWD button............................57  
Cue & Review function using the SHUTTLE feature......57  
Digital scrubbing using the SCRUB function..................58  
Formatting a Disk.....................................................................27  
Recordingmode....................................................................27  
Formatting the current drive (SCSI disk)........................28  
Formatting the current drive (E-IDE hard disk).............30  
Formatting a backup disk (SCSI disk)...............................30  
Formatting a backup disk (fixed disk).............................31  
PreviewFunction......................................................................59  
Executing the Preview function.........................................59  
Trimming the sound while previewing...........................60  
HandlingPrograms..................................................................32  
Editing Tracks...........................................................................61  
Creating a new Program....................................................32  
Using a Program Change function....................................33  
Deleting a Program...........................................................34  
Editing a Program title......................................................35  
Copy & Paste and Move & Paste......................................61  
Storing the edit points......................................................62  
Checking and adjusting the edit points.......................62  
Executing Copy (or Move)..............................................62  
Checking the clipboard data..........................................62  
Executing Paste..................................................................63  
Undo/redo Paste...............................................................63  
Erase..................................................................................64  
Storing the edit points......................................................65  
Checking and adjusting the edit points.......................65  
ExecutingErase..................................................................65  
Undo/redoErase...............................................................65  
Track Exchange.................................................................66  
Executing Track Exchange..............................................67  
Punch In/Out Recording.........................................................36  
What is Punch In/Out recording?.....................................36  
Auto Punch In/Out...............................................................36  
Preparation...................................................................36  
Rehearsing auto punch in/out recording...................38  
Auto punch in/out Take.................................................39  
Undo/redo auto punch in/out recording...................39  
Manual Punch In/Out recording......................................40  
preparation...................................................................40  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Table of Contents)  
MIDI Sync function...................................................................68  
Explanation on the command/mode list...........................113  
The status request command.............................................115  
Explanation on the status reply...........................................116  
Maintenance/Specifications..............................................118  
MIDI clock sync system....................................................68  
MTC sync/MIDI Machine Control system.......................70  
External MIDI equipment sync system by the  
slave mode................................................................... ..73  
SavingandLoadingSongData.............................................75  
Outline of the save/load operation..................................75  
Saving and loading data using a SCSI drive  
as the current drive...................................................78  
Saving/loading data using another SCSI drive...........78  
SCSI drive connection and preparation...............78  
Saving data.................................................................79  
Loading data...............................................................80  
Saving/loading via a DAT or adat.................................81  
Saving and loading data using an 3.5-inch  
E-IDE hard disk as the current drive......................82  
Saving song data via a DAT or adat...............................82  
DAT (or adat) connection and preparation........82  
Saving data.................................................................83  
Loading song data via a DAT or adat............................84  
DAT (or adat) connection and preparation........84  
Loading data...............................................................85  
Saving and loading song data via a SCSI drive............86  
Quick Troubleshooting...................................................87  
ChangingtheInitialSettings(SETUPmode)......................88  
Selecting SETUP mode.........................................................89  
Setting a time signature.......................................................90  
Setting a tempo.....................................................................92  
Setting the metronome function.......................................93  
Setting a preroll value..........................................................94  
Setting MIDI sync output signal.........................................95  
Setting an MTC frame rate..................................................96  
Setting an MTC offset value................................................96  
Setting MTC Offset mode....................................................97  
Setting the slave mode ........................................................98  
Setting the slave type...........................................................99  
Setting the Record Protect function...............................100  
Setting digital input tracks...............................................101  
Setting digital output tracks.............................................102  
Setting BAR/BEAT resolution mode...............................103  
Setting the MIDI device number.....................................104  
Checking the number of each track events..................105  
MIDI Implementation Chart..................................................106  
MMC Command List/Inquiry Message List....................107  
Fostex System Exclusive Message...................................108  
Status Request.......................................................................109  
Data Type.................................................................................111  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Introduction/Main features/Precautions)  
• An “Undo/Redo function” enables you to easily correct  
recording and editing mistakes.  
Introduction  
Thank you for purchasing the Fostex Model VR800.  
The VR800 is a 8-track digital multitrack recorder with  
sixteen additional tracks that employs a 3.5-inch E-IDE  
type removable hard disk, or external SCSI device  
(removable or fixed) as the recording media, instead of  
conventional type.  
• A “Vari Pitch function” allows you to fine-tune the pitch.  
• The VR800 has a “digital input track setup” function that  
enables you to input S/P DIF or adat digital signals and record  
them on any two tracks or all eight tracks.  
• The VR800 has a “digital output track setup” function that  
enables you to output digital data as S/P DIF or adat digital  
signals and record them on an external digital device (DAT,  
MD, adat, etc.).  
The VR800 is a digital multitrack recorder that is designed  
to connect to a digital mixing console using optical cables.  
For recording media, it uses 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disks,  
removable disks, such as SCSI Zip and MO drive disks, or  
fixed disks to provide you with a maximum of eight tracks  
of simultaneous recording and playback, along with 16  
additional tracks.  
• You can also use the DATA IN/OUT jacks to an external DAT  
or adat, and to save and load songdata (audio data and  
SETUP mode settings) to and from the DAT or adat.  
• High-speed SCSI Save/Load is also an option by connecting a  
non-DAT or adat SCSI backup drive.  
The VR800 records uncompressed digital audio using  
16-bit linear quantization, and a sampling frequency of  
44.1kHz, which enables you to configure a completely  
digital recording system that combines various digital  
mixers. Adopting A.D.A.C (*) has expanded the disk  
recording capacity by a factor of four. You can select  
one of three recording modes, depending on the  
recording media and application.  
• A maximum of 99 Locate Pointers can be programmed for a  
LOCATE only feature. Simply select the LOCATE number  
desired for swift location.  
• MIDI clock and Song Position Pointer can be transmitted  
according to the internal programmable Tempo Map.  
You can set up a synchronization system with a sequencer or  
a rhythm machine without wasting a track.  
• You can use the VR800 as a sync slave machine by sending  
MTC from a connected device.  
You can back up data to DAT tapes or to an adat using a  
special adat back-up function. SCSI ports permit fast back-  
up.  
• The VR800 supports MTC, MMC, and Fostex System Exclusive  
Message, which allows for advanced control and high-  
precision synchronization from external sequencing software.  
You can set the device number and MTC frame rate for MMC  
and Fostex System Exclusive Message. Also, “MTC Offset  
function” and “Offset Mode function” are useful for setting  
up a sync environment using an external sequencing software.  
Using an optional Model VC-8 (adat-analog converter)  
allows you to connect an analog mixer to the VR800.  
Please read this Owner’s Manual and the Quick Operation  
Guide.  
• Auto Punch In/Out and Manual Punch In/Out functions offer  
two modes: “Take” for a real recording, and “Rehearsal” for  
monitoring the part between the in and out points.  
• The “Program Select function” enables you to select a song  
from up to 99 songs and name the songs.  
Main features  
The VR800’s recorder section uses a recording format  
called FDMS-3 (Fostex Disk Management System-3). It  
uses an 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk, external SCSI device  
(stationary disk or removable disk) as the recording  
media.  
• A “Bar/Beat Resolution function” is used to edit audio at the  
beginning of the beat (round up or round off to a beat).  
• The “Metronome function” can be used as a rhythm guide  
for recording.  
• Various edit functions using an edit point (locate point), such  
as Copy & Paste, Move & Paste, Erase, Auto Punch In/Out,  
Auto Locate, are available. You can also locate ABS 0 or REC  
END regardless of the edit point (locate point).  
• The VR800 features a 3.5-inch bay for easy installation of a  
3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk. A SCSI connector enables you to  
connect a SCSI device (removable or fixed) as the current or  
back-up drive.  
• You can set a preroll time of 0 to 10 seconds.  
• The VR800 features non-destructive audio editing (a great  
advantage of digital recording) such as Copy & Paste, Move  
& Paste, Erase, etc. You can choose Time Base (ABS or MTC)  
or MIDI bar/beat/clock as the unit.  
• A “Disk Remain Display function” offers a clear indication  
of available recording time and disk space (in mono track  
recording). You can choose the Time Base from ABS, MTC,  
and BAR/BEAT/CLK.  
• A “Preview function” allows for an intuitive fine-adjustment  
of an editing point (locate point).  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Introduction/Main features/Precautions)  
• If you move the unit from a place with an excessively low  
Precautions  
temperature to a warm place, or if you use the unit in a room  
in which the temperature varies significantly during winter,  
condensation may occur on the hard disk or other parts. In  
such cases, leave the unit for about an hour in the new location  
before you turn on the power.  
• Be sure to connect the VR800 to the power supply specified  
in the Specifications section of this Owner’s Manual. Do not  
use an AC outlet of any other voltage.  
• Do not connect the VR800 to the same AC outlet to which  
devices that could generate noise (such as a large motor or  
dimmer), or the devices that consume a large amount of  
power (such as an air conditioning system or large electric  
heater) are connected.  
Note on repair  
• This unit does not use any parts that users can repair easily.  
Contact your dealer or the nearest FOSTEX service station to  
ask about repairs.  
• If you use the unit in an area with a different power voltage,  
first consult your dealer or the nearest FOSTEX service station.  
You can use the unit with a power frequency of 50Hz or  
60Hz.  
• Use the packing carton designed for the VR800 when you  
transport the unit to the dealer for repair or return.  
If you have discarded the packing box, try to pack the unit  
completely using shock absorbing materials. Fostex is not  
responsible for malfunction or damage due to incomplete  
packaging or caused during transport.  
• It is very dangerous to use a power cord that is frayed or  
damage. In such a case, stop using the unit immediately and  
ask your dealer to repair the cord.  
• To avoid possible electric shock and damage to the VR800,  
avoid contact with water or other liquids, or do not handle  
the power plug while your hands are wet.  
About copyrights  
• It is prohibited by law to use any part of a CD recording or  
video images or audio data for which copyright is possessed  
by a third party for commercial purposes such as contents,  
broadcasts, sales, or distribution- any purpose other than  
for your personal pleasure.  
• To prevent possible electric shock and damage to the VR800,  
do not remove the main unit cover or reach the inside the  
unit.  
• Do not let water or other liquid, or metal objects such as  
pins, accidentally enter the inside of the unit because this  
may lead to electric shock or damage. Should water enter  
the inside of the unit, remove the power plug from the AC  
outlet, and consult your dealer or the nearest FOSTEX service  
station.  
About damage  
• FOSTEX is not responsible for any “direct damage” or  
“indirect damage” caused by using the VR800.  
• To prevent damage to the VR800, be sure to power on the  
connected devices first, then turn on the power to the VR800.  
• Before turning the power off to the VR800, first quit Setup  
mode and make sure that the recorder section is stopped.  
Especially, never attempt to turn off the power to the unit  
while the hard disk is accessing data (the HD ACCESS LED is  
lit or flashing). Otherwise, not only will you lose recorded  
data, but you may damage to the unit.  
FOSTEX is not responsible for the data lost during operation  
of the unit.  
• Before you change the location of the VR800, pack the unit  
in the shipping carton or an impact-resistant case.  
Make sure that the unit is kept free from external vibration  
or impact since the unit is very sensitive to vibration.  
• Do not install the unit in locations subject to the following:  
* Extremely high or low temperature, or significant changes  
in temperature.  
* Excessive humidity or dust.  
* Excessive changes in power supply voltage  
* Unstable or significantly vibrating or shaking surfaces.  
* Near a strong magnetic field (such as a TV or speaker).  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
Names and Functions  
Rear panel  
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
Top panel  
Side panel  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
IN  
OUT  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
STOP  
RECORD  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
Top Panel  
Letters in brackets ([ ]) are labels on the panel.  
2
3
4
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
1
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
5
30  
29  
28  
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
IN  
OUT  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
27  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
9
10  
PGM SEL  
26  
25  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
11  
12  
STOP  
RECORD  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
13  
14  
17 16  
22  
19 18  
24  
15  
21 20  
23  
1. Record track select keys [RECORD TRACK (1 - 8)]  
Refer to page 24 for more information on playback monitoring  
and input monitoring.  
These keys enable you to select SAFE or READY for a  
recording track. Pressing the key once will cause the  
corresponding track to enter the READY mode, and the lamp  
of the key you pressed to flash. Pressing the key again will  
cause the corresponding track to enter the SAFE mode, and  
the lamp to turn off. When you start recording on a track  
in READY mode, the flashing lamp remain lit.  
If you press only the RECORD button with a track in READY  
mode, you can monitor the signal input to the READY track  
so that you can adjust the recording level. To cancel this  
input monitoring status, press the RECORD button again.  
This puts the VR800 in playback monitoring mode.  
You can also use these select keys to select tracks to Copy &  
Paste, Move & Paste, Erase and other editing features, as  
well as to execute the digital scrubbing.  
2. Access LED [ACCESS]  
This LED light up or flashes when data is being written to or  
read from an external SCSI current drive disk, or 3.5-inch  
internal E-IDE hard disk.  
Note: Do not turn off the power to the VR800 when this  
LED lights up or flashes. Otherwise you may lose data on  
the hard disk connected to the VR800.  
3.LCD  
The LCD indicates signal levels and various settings.  
Note: You can record on real tracks 1–8 in real-time, but  
not on additional tracks 9–24. If you are using an MO drive  
as the current drive, you can record only two tracks  
simultaneously. If you try to record more than two tracks by  
setting them to READY mode, [Track Over !] appears and  
READY mode will cancel.  
Refer to “Display Section” on page 16 for more information  
on the display.  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
4.Contrast adjustment knob  
8. Execute/Yes key [EXECUTE/YES]  
Use this knob to adjust the contrast of the LCD. Turning  
this knob clockwise will increase the contrast, and turning  
it counter-clockwise will decrease the contrast.  
Press this key to confirm the edit operations, such as Copy  
& Paste, Move & Paste, and Erase, and to set the parameters  
of SETUP menus.  
Note: The display is not unreadable if you leave the knob  
counter-clockwise all the way.  
9.Display indication select key [DISP SEL]  
Pressing this key each time will change the display indication  
as follows:  
Currently-selected Time Base indication *1  
Currently-selected Time Base REMAIN indication *2  
External MTC IN indication *3  
5.Clipboard In key [CLIPBOARD IN/ PREVIEW ]  
Use this key to store the start point of audio data to be  
copied or moved. When you press this key, the VR800  
displays data currently stored, and you can edit the data.  
After editing the data, press the STORE key, then press the  
CLIPBOARD IN key to store the edited data in this key. The  
stored data can be used as locate data.  
If you press the CLIPBOARD IN key while holding down the  
SHIFT key when the recorder is stopped, you can preview  
the fade-in part at the stored CLIPBOARD IN point.  
*1 The current position in terms of time base selected via the TIME  
BASE SEL key appears. ABS time, MTC time, or BAR/BEAT/CLK is  
used.  
*2 Available recording time and space on the current SCSI disk will  
appear. The time indication uses the currently-selected time base  
(ABS, MTC, or BAR/BEAT/CLK). The space indication uses MB  
(Megabyte). (The values are based on mono track recording.)  
* Refer to page 51 for more information on setting and editing  
the locate point.  
* Refer to page 61 for more information on the Copy & Paste/  
Move & Paste functions.  
*3 MTC being input from an external MIDI device to the VR800 appears.  
* Refer to page 59 for more information on previewing data  
at the CLIPBOARD IN point  
If no MTC is input, the display will show “00H 00M 00S 00F.”  
10. Setup key [SETUP]  
6.Clipboard Out key [CLIPBOARD OUT/ PREVIEW ]  
Use this key to store the end point of audio data to be copied  
or moved. When you press this key, the VR800 displays  
currently-stored data, which you can edit. After editing the  
data, press the STORE key, then press the CLIPBOARD OUT  
key to store the edited data in this key. The stored data can  
be used as locate data.  
Press this key to set the VR800 in SETUP mode to execute  
various menus. This key works only when the VR800 is  
stopped.  
Refer to page 88 for more information on SETUP mode.  
If you press the CLIPBOARD OUT key while holding down  
the SHIFT key when the recorder is stopped, you can preview  
the fade-out part at the stored CLIPBOARD OUT point.  
11. Undo/Redo key [UNDO/REDO]  
If you wish to restore the status prior to editing, recording,  
or performing a punch in/out take, press the UNDO/REDO  
key. Pressing the UNDO/REDO key again will restore the  
status obtained before you pressed the UNDO/REDO key  
the first time.  
* Refer to page 51 for more information on setting and editing  
the locate point.  
* Refer to page 61 for more information on the Copy & Paste/  
Move & Paste functions.  
When you undo the operation, [Undo!] will appear. When  
you redo the operation, [Redo!] will appears on the display.  
* Refer to page 59 for more information on previewing data  
at the CLIPBOARD OUT point  
Note: The Undo/Redo function works only when the VR800  
7. Exit/No key [EXIT/NO/ EJECT ]  
is stopped.  
This key is the counterpart of the EXECUTE/YES key.  
Press this key to cancel an operation.  
Refer to pages 39, 42, 63, 65 and “Quick operation guide” for  
more information on the Undo/Redo function.  
When you use a removable SCSI disk, pressing this key while  
holding down the SHIFT key will eject the disk.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
12. Edit key [EDIT]  
15. Time Base select key [TIME BASE SEL]  
Pressing this key enters the VR800 to the menu select mode  
for editing tracks, and displays the title of the menu you  
used last time. Press this key repeatedly or turn the JOG  
dial to select a menu. The edit menus appear in the following  
order. To execute a desired menu, select the menu, then  
press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
Pressing this key repeatedly will switch time base as follows:  
ABS time  
BAR/BEAT/CLK  
MTC time  
To exit selection mode, press the EXIT/NO key.  
Copy Clip  
Move Clip  
16. Locate key [LOCATE/ LOC MEM ]  
Use this key to start the LOCATE feature.  
Pressing this key after a memory key (CLIPBOARD IN/OUT,  
AUTO RTN START/END, AUTO PUNCH IN/OUT) locates the  
memory data programmed in each respective key (time  
mode or bar, beat, clock setting).  
Copy Paste (or Move Paste *)  
Erase  
The data can be programmed by individually setting it with  
one of the 99 (01-99) locate numbers of the LOCATE key.  
TRK Exchange  
Note that the data of locate number 00 is available in  
addition to locate numbers 01-99. The last locate time setting  
(bar, beat, clock setting) constantly replaces the data stored  
in the LOCATE key as data in locate number 00. Therefore,  
it is possible to press this key alone to repeatedly locate the  
same point.  
(*) After you execute copy clip, “Copy Paste” appears. After you execute  
move clip, “Move Paste” appears.  
* Refer to page 61 for more information on Copy & Paste  
and Move & Paste.  
* Refer to page 64 for more information on Erase.  
Pressing the LOCATE key while holding down the SHIFT key  
will cause the VR800 to enter edit mode, in which you can  
edit data stored in the LOCATE key.  
* Refer to page 66 for more information on Track Exchange.  
* Refer to page 54 for more information on the Locate  
function.  
13. JOG dial [JOG/ SHUTTLE ]  
When the VR800 is stopped, use the JOG dial to perform a  
jog operation (forward or reverse) for audio scrubbing  
without pitch change. You can also use this dial to increase  
and decrease the numeric values or input alphabetical  
characters in edit mode.  
* Refer to page 51 for more information on editing data  
using the LOCATE key.  
17.Auto Return/Auto Play mode on/off key  
Rotating the JOG dial while holding down the SHIFT key  
will enable you to perform the shuttle operation with  
different speeds ranging from normal speed to 64-times  
speed.  
[AUTO RTN/AUTO PLAY]  
Use this key to turn on and off auto return mode, auto play  
mode, and auto repeat mode. Each time you press the key,  
the mode will change and the following indication displayed.  
Auto Return/Play mode is OFF.  
(No indication)  
AUTO  
Refer to page 57 for more information on the cue/review  
function and the shuttle function.  
Auto Play mode is ON.  
(“PLAY” lights up.)  
AUTO  
PLAY  
14. Scrub key [SCRUB]  
Pressing this key causes its lamp to light up as the VR800  
will enter the digital scrub mode. At this point, press the  
desired RECORD TRACK select key to digitally scrub the  
selected track playback using the JOG dial.  
Auto Return mode is ON.  
(“RTN” lights up.)  
AUTO  
AUTO  
RTN  
RTN  
Auto Repeat mode is ON.  
PLAY  
(Both “PLAY” and “RTN” light up.)  
Refer to page 58 for more information on Digital Scrub mode.  
* Auto Play mode  
The VR800 locates a point and starts playing from the locate point.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
* Auto Return mode  
20. Fast forward button [F FWD]  
When the AUTO RTN END point is reached while the recorder section is  
playing, the VR800 automatically locate the AUTO RTN START point.  
This mode is effective only if the AUTO RTN START point and the AUTO  
RTN END point have already been specified.  
Pressing this button while the VR800 is stopped will start  
fast forwarding at low speed at first, then gradually  
accelerate to 30-times speed. If you press this button while  
the VR800 is playing, cueing (fast forwarding with sound)  
starts at three-time speed. Pressing this button while holding  
down the STOP button will activate the “LOCATE REC END”  
operation, which will locate the end point of the recording  
on the real track in the current program. You can also use  
this button to locate an edit point in edit mode.  
Note: The auto return function is enabled only when the  
VR800 is playing. While the VR800 is recording, the VR800  
will not locate the START point after it reaches the AUTO  
RTN END point.  
*Auto Repeat mode  
This mode is effective only when auto play mode and auto return mode are  
turned on. The VR800 will play the part between the AUTO RTN START  
point and the AUTO RTN END point repeatedly. This mode is also effective  
only if the AUTO RTN START point and the AUTO RTN END point have  
already been specified.  
Refer to the “STOP button” section and page 48 for more  
information on the “LOCATE REC END” operation.  
21. Rewind button [REWIND]  
Pressing this button while the VR800 is stopped will start  
rewinding at low speed at first, and then gradually increase  
speed up to 30-times speed. If you press this button while  
the VR800 is playing, cueing (rewinding with sound) starts  
at three-times speed. Pressing this button while holding  
down the STOP button will activate the “LOCATE ABS 0”  
operation, which will locate the beginning of the current  
program (ABS time: 00m 00s 00f). You can also use this  
button to locate an edit point in edit mode.  
Refer to page 54 for more information on each mode.  
18.Vari Pitch key [VARI PITCH/ P.EDIT ]  
This key toggles vari pitch mode on and off. When vari  
pitch mode is on, the “VARI PITCH” indicator lights up on  
the display, and the VR800 plays using the current pitch  
data. Pressing the VARI PITCH key while holding down the  
SHIFT key will cause the VR800 to enter edit mode, in which  
you can change pitch data in real-time.  
Refer to the “STOP button” section and page 48 for more  
information on the “LOCATE ABS 0” operation.  
To exit edit mode, press the EXIT/NO key.  
Refer to Quick operation guide for more information on  
playing with Vari Pitch and editing Vari Pitch data.  
22. Play button [PLAY]  
Pressing this button causes the recorder section to play back.  
Pressing this button while holding down the RECORD button  
when a track is in READY mode will cause the VR800 to  
start recording on the READY track.  
19. Shift key [ SHIFT ]  
Press a key, button, or turn the dial while holding down the  
SHIFT key to activate the following “shift-invoked” functions.  
Pressing only this button during the recording operation  
will punch-out (cancel) recording. Pressing this button while  
holding down the STOP button will cause the “CLIPBOARD  
PLAY” operation to start.  
You can audition the data at edit points  
The removable SCSI disk is  
ejected. (Refer to “Formatting a  
disk” on page 31.)  
(locate points) stored in the memory  
keys. (For more information, refer to  
“Preview function” on page 59.)  
* Refer to the “STOP button” section and page 62 for more  
information on the “CLIPBOARD PLAY” operation.  
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
NO  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
/
YES  
IN  
OUT  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
* Refer to page 41 for more information on the Punch Out  
operation using the PLAY button.  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
The SHUTTLE  
f u n c t i o n i s  
activated. (Refer  
to “Cue & review  
function using the  
S H U T T L E  
function” on page  
57 for more  
information.)  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
23. Stop button [STOP]  
STOP  
RECORD  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
Pressing this button during the playback, recording, fast  
forward, or rewind operation will stop the recorder transport  
operation. Pressing this button while the VR800 is in SETUP  
mode will cause the unit to exit SETUP mode.  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
Auto punch mode  
turned on and off.  
(Refer to “Punch  
In/Out” on page  
36.)  
You can edit locate data stored  
in the LOCATE key. (Refer to  
“Storing an edit point (locate  
point)” on page 48 for more  
information.  
Pressing the PLAY, REWIND, or F FWD button while holding  
down the STOP button will start the following operations.  
If you wish to rehearse the manual Punch In/Out operation  
using the foot switch, press the foot switch while holding  
down this button to enter the rehearsal mode.  
You can edit Vari Pitch  
data. (Refer to Quick  
operation guide for more  
information on “Playback  
in Vari Pitch mode”.)  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
25. Store key [STORE]  
PLAY  
“CLIPBOARD PLAY” operation starts. (See  
This is the key for registering (storing) the time (or BAR/  
BEAT/CLK figures) for ABS or MTC into any memory key or  
LOCATE key. The key lamp will be lit when this is pressed  
and together with a display of [Press LOC:], the locate  
number will blink. When registering time data in a memory  
key such as AUTO PUNCH IN, any memory key can be  
pressed by ignoring this [Press LOC:] display, when  
registering in the LOCATE key, specify any locate number  
(01~99) while [Press LOC:] is displayed, then press the  
LOCATE key. In either case, the STORE key lamp will be  
extinguished simultaneous with the completion of time data  
registering, and return to the original time base display.  
After pressing this key, if you wish to cancel the store  
operation, press the EXIT/NO key, or STOP button.  
below.) . During the operation, the STOP  
lamp flashes and the PLAY lamp lights up.  
STOP  
REW  
ABS 0 is located. (See below.)  
F FWD  
REC END is located. (See below.)  
* CLIPBOARD PLAY operation  
The CLIPBOARD PLAY operation plays back data on the clipboard. (If the  
clipboard does not contain any data, the display shows [Void Data !] and  
nothing happens.). During this operation, the display indicates the type of  
the data (“Copy Clip” for copy data, and “Move Clip” for move data), and the  
duration. The indicator of the copy source or move source track will flash.  
This way, you will know which track the currently playing data comes from  
and why the data is on the clipboard.  
Press the STORE key, and press the CLIPBOARD IN key.  
The CLIPBOARD IN point will be stored.  
This data can be used as locate data.  
Press the STORE key, and press the CLIPBOARD OUT key.  
The CLIPBOARD OUT point will be stored.  
This data can be used as locate data.  
Press the STORE key, and press the AUTO PUNCH IN key.  
The AUTO PUNCH IN point will be stored.  
* ABS 0 locate operation  
This operation locates the beginning of the current program (ABS time:  
00m 00s 00f).  
This data can be used as locate data.  
Press the STORE key, and press the AUTO PUNCH OUT key.  
The AUTO PUNCH OUT point will be stored.  
This data can be used as locate data.  
* REC END locate operation  
This operation locates the end of the audio recording (REC END) on the  
real track in the current program.  
Press the STORE key, and press the AUTO RTN START key.  
The AUTO RTN START point will be stored.  
* Refer to page 54 for more information on these operations.  
* Refer to page 40 for more information on the Punch In/  
Out operation using a foot switch.  
This data can be used as locate data.  
Press the STORE key, and press the AUTO RTN END key.  
The AUTO RTN END point will be stored.  
This data can be used as locate data.  
24. Record button [RECORD/ AUTO PUNCH ]  
Pressing the PLAY button while holding down this button  
will start the VR800 recording any READY tracks.  
The flashing lamp of the RECORD TRACK select key for the  
corresponding READY track will light steadily, and the PLAY  
lamp and the RECORD lamp light.  
Specify locate number and press LOCATE key  
The specified locate number will be stored as locate data.  
A maximum 99 locate numbers can be registered.  
If you press the STORE key and the HOLD/> key  
simultaneously while the recorder is stopped, the VR800  
will enter the program select mode, in which you can select  
a program or set up a new one.  
If you press only the RECORD button, a READY real track  
enters input monitoring mode (The RECORD lamp flashes.).  
At this time, pressing the RECORD button again will cancel  
the input monitoring mode, and the track will return to the  
playback monitoring mode.  
* Refer to page 54 for more information on the Locate function.  
* Refer to page 48 for more information on storing edit points  
(locate points).  
Pressing the RECORD button while holding down the SHIFT  
key will toggle between AUTO PUNCH on and off.  
* Refer to page 32 for more information on the Program Select  
function.  
* Refer to page 36 for more information on AUTO PUNCH  
mode.  
26. Hold/> key [HOLD/>]  
Pressing the HOLD/> key while the recorder is operating  
will cause the VR800 to capture the time when you pressed  
it (or bar/beat/clock value), display it, and then enter edit  
mode. (If you press the HOLD/> key while the recorder  
section is stopped, the VR800 enter edit mode directly.)  
To cancel edit mode, press the STOP button, DISP SEL key,  
or the EXIT/NO key.  
* Refer to page 24 for more information on input monitoring  
and playback monitoring.  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
In edit mode, you can use this key to select a digit of the  
value to edit (edit point). You can select a digit which flashes  
on the display) in the following order.  
* Refer to page 48 for more information on setting and editing  
the AUTO RTN START point.  
* Refer to page 54 for more information on the Auto Return  
and Auto Repeat functions.  
ABS or MTC is used as time base:  
First, “S” (second) flashes. Each time you press the HOLD/> key,  
the flashing characters change in this order: F -> SF -> H -> M-> S.  
* Refer to page 59 for more information on previewing data  
at the AUTO RTN START point.  
BAR/BEAT/CLK is used as time base:  
29. Auto Punch In key [AUTO PUNCH IN/ PREVIEW ]  
Use this key to store the punch in (recording start) point  
for the auto punch In/Out function. The stored data is also  
used as a paste start point (for Copy & Paste, Move & Paste)  
and as an erase start point.  
First, “BAR” flashes. Each time you press the HOLD/> key, the  
flashing indicator changes in this order: -> CLK -> BAR.  
If you press the HOLD/> key and the STORE key simultaneously  
while the recorder is stopped, the VR800 will enter the program  
select mode, in which you can select a program or set up a new  
one.  
When you press this key, the VR800 will display currently-  
stored data, which you can then edit. After editing the  
data, press the STORE key, then the AUTO PUNCH IN key to  
store edited data in this key. The stored data can be used  
as locate data.  
* Refer to page 48 for more information on editing memory.  
* Refer to page 32 for more information on the Program  
Select function.  
If you press the AUTO PUNCH IN key while holding down the  
SHIFT key when the recorder is stopped, you can preview the  
fade-out part at the stored AUTO PUNCH IN point.  
27. Auto Return End key [AUTO RTN END/ PREVIEW ]  
Use this key to store the start point (AUTO RTN END point)  
for the auto return function and the auto repeat function.  
When you press this key, the VR800 will display currently-  
stored data, which you can edit. After editing the data, press  
the STORE key, then press the AUTO RTN END key to store  
the edited data in this key. The stored data can be used as  
locate data.  
* Refer to page 48 for more information on setting and editing  
the locate point.  
* Refer to page 36 for more information on the Auto Punch  
In/Out functions.  
* Refer to page 59 for more information on previewing data  
at the AUTO PUNCH IN point.  
If you press the AUTO RTN END key while holding down  
the SHIFT key when the recorder is stopped, you can preview  
the fade-out part at the stored AUTO RTN END point.  
30. Auto Punch Out key  
[AUTO PUNCH OUT/ PREVIEW ]  
Use this key to store the punch out (recording end) point  
for the auto punch In/Out function. The stored data is also  
used as an erase end point.  
* Refer to page 48 for more information on setting and  
editing the locate point.  
* Refer to page 54 for more information on the Auto Return  
and Auto Repeat functions.  
When you press this key, the VR800 will display currently-  
stored data, which you can then edit. After editing the data,  
press the STORE key, and then the AUTO PUNCH OUT key  
to store the edited data in this key. The stored data can be  
used as locate data.  
* Refer to page 59 for more information on previewing data  
at the AUTO RTN END point.  
28. Auto Return Start key  
If you press the AUTO PUNCH OUT key while holding down the  
SHIFT key when the recorder is stopped, you can preview the  
fade-in part at the stored AUTO PUNCH OUT point.  
[AUTO RTN START/ PREVIEW ]  
Use this key to store the start point (AUTO RTN START point)  
for the auto return function and the auto repeat function.  
When you press this key, the VR800 displays the currently-  
stored data, which you can edit. After editing the data, press  
the STORE key, then the AUTO RTN START key to store the  
edited data in this key. The stored data can be used as  
locate data.  
* Refer to page 48 for more information on setting and editing  
the locate point.  
* Refer to page 36 for more information on the Auto Punch  
In/Out functions.  
* Refer to page 59 for more information on previewing data  
at the AUTO PUNCH OUT point.  
This memory is reset to the factory default value when you  
turn off the power to the VR800.  
If you press the AUTO RTN START key while holding down  
the SHIFT key when the recorder is stopped, you can preview  
the fade-in part at the stored AUTO RTN START point.  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
Rear Panel  
1
2 3  
4
5
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
7
8
6
3. Data input jack [DATA IN] (Connector: OPTICAL)  
This is connected to the OPTICAL digital output of the  
external digital mixer. This is also connected to the OPTICAL  
digital output (or adat out) of any external digital equipment  
in use when digitally recording on the VR800 from external  
digital equipment (MD, DAT, CD, adat, etc.).  
1. SCSI connector [SCSI] (Connector: D-SUB 25-pin)  
Connect a SCSI device as a current drive or backup device  
to SAVE/LOAD data. Up to two SCSI devices can be  
connected to the SCSI connector. This means the current  
drive and backup SCSI equipment can be connected in a  
chain.  
DATA  
IN  
SCSI  
* Refer to the “Quick Operation Guide” for more information  
on connecting theexternal digital mixer.  
* Refer to page 45 for more information on digital recording to  
external digital device.  
* Refer to the “Quick Operation Guide” for information on  
connecting an external SCSI drive.  
* Refer to page 75 for more details on SAVE/LOAD using a  
SCSI device.  
* Refer to page 75 for more information on saving and loading  
song data.  
2. Data output jack [DATA OUT] (Connector: OPTICAL)  
This is connected to the OPTICAL digital input of the external  
digital mixer. This is also connected to the OPTICAL digital  
input (or adat in) of the external digital equipment in use  
when digital recording in external digital equipment (MD,  
DAT, CD-R, etc.) from the VR800 or when saving song data  
in external DAT or adat.  
Note: You can load the data recorded on the current  
drive formatted in [Master 8ch] mode and [Master 4ch]  
mode from a DAT. You cannot load data recorded in  
[ADAC 8ch] mode from a DAT. You can load only the  
data recorded on the current drive formatted in [Master  
8ch] mode from a adat.  
DATA  
OUT  
4. MIDI OUT jack [MIDI OUT] (Connector: DIN 5-pin)  
Connect this jack to the MIDI IN jack of an external MIDI  
device. This jack transmits MTC (MIDI timecode), MIDI clock  
& Song Position Pointer, MMC (MIDI Machine Control)  
command, response, and FEX (Fostex System Exclusive  
Message) response.  
* Refer to the “Quick Operation Guide” for more information  
on connecting theexternal digital mixer.  
* Refer to page 45 for more information on digital recording to  
external digital device.  
* Refer to page 75 for more information on saving and loading  
song data.  
MIDI  
OUT  
Note: You can save the data recorded on the current  
drive formatted in [Master 8ch] mode and [Master 4ch]  
mode to a DAT. You cannot save data recorded in [ADAC  
8ch] mode. You can save only the data recorded on the  
current drive formatted in [Master 8ch] mode to a adat.  
Refer to page 68 for more information on the example of using  
the MIDI OUT jack.  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
5. MIDI IN jack [MIDI IN] (Connector: DIN 5-pin)  
7. AC IN connector  
Connect this jack to the MIDI OUT jack of an external MIDI  
device. You can control the VR800 remotely by inputting  
MMC (MIDI Machine Control) command or FEX (Fostex  
System Exclusive Message) here.  
The power cable packaged with this recorder ia connected  
here.  
Note: Always plug the power cable to the recorder before  
plugging the cable into the wall outlet.  
MIDI  
IN  
8. Power switch [POWER]  
Refer to page 68 for more information on using the MIDI IN  
jack.  
This switch turns power on and off to the VR800.  
6. Word Out jack [WORD OUT] (Connector: BNC)  
Word clock signal from the VR800 is output here.  
This jack and WORD IN of the external digital equipment  
must be connected if the WORD IN connector ia provided  
in the external digital equipment (digital mixer, etc.) which  
is connected to the VR800.  
Refer to the separate “Quick Operation Guide” for operating  
procedures.  
Side Panel  
1
1. Punch in/out jack [PUNCH IN/OUT] (Connector: phone)  
Using an optional foot switch connected to this jack enables  
you to perform the manual punch In/Out operation  
(including rehearsal) using your foot. Connect an optional  
Fostex foot switch, Model 8051.  
PUNCH  
IN/OUT  
Refer to page 40 for more information on using the PUNCH  
IN/OUT jack.  
Note: Be sure to use an “unlatch type” foot switch if you  
use a foot switch other than the Model 8051. Otherwise, a  
malfunction could occur.  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
Display Section  
The VR800 uses a liquid crystal display which integrates a 9-digit/35-dot message section, 7-segment display section, and  
level meters. The level meters indicate the output level of tracks 1-8.  
The time display shows various information in different units, such as ABS time (absolute time), MTC (MIDI timecode), BAR/  
BEAT/CLK (bar/beat/clock), and makes it easy to check the recorder’s current time. The message display shows various  
messages required to operate the VR800, and offers interactive operation. This section describes display functions along with  
examples.  
Preset display  
Display when the power is turned on  
The display below shows all preset items for explanation  
purposes.  
When you turn on the power to the VR800 and the  
connected external SCSI drive (a formatted removable disk  
or hard disk), the display shows the [Initial...] message,  
[Current Dr], the name of the connected current drive, then  
recording mode (Master 8ch, Master 4ch, or ADAC 8ch),  
and finally the top position of the disk in the time base  
(ABS, MTC, or BAR/BEAT/CLK) used in the last program  
before you turned the power off.  
MTC DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
MIDI  
SLAVE  
SETUP  
OFFSET  
MTC  
BAR  
M
CLK  
MB  
REMAIN  
ABS  
LOC  
H
S
F
SF  
%
MTC IN  
VARI PITCH  
PGM  
TEMPO  
SURE ?  
COMPLETED!  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
The following example indicates that the VR800 started with  
the ABS time base used in program 1.  
CLK  
MTC  
IDE  
SCSI  
TAKE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
RHSL  
PLAY  
RTN  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
The level meter shows the recorder output level and the  
recording level for tracks 1~8.  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Lights up when ABS is selected as time base.  
Lights up when MTC is selected as time base.  
ABS  
MTC  
When the VR800  
recognizes the current  
drive, the [SCSI]  
indicator lights up in the  
[DRIVE] section of the  
display if the current  
drive is a SCSI device.  
The [IDE] indicator  
lights up if the current  
drive is an E-IDE hard  
disk.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Lights up to indicate available recording time and  
space on the disk.  
REMAIN  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
AUTO  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
Lights up when the VR800 enters SETUP mode.  
A.PUNCH  
Lights up when an edit operation (copy, move,  
paste, or erase) is completed.  
COMPLETED !  
The name of the SCSI drive (The name is  
different, depending on the type of device.)  
Lights up to confirm or cancel the operation when  
you are making settings or edits.  
SURE ?  
MTC OFFSET  
PGM  
Lights up when the MTC Offset menu is selected in  
SETUP mode.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Indicating a recording  
mode used during for-  
matting.  
Lights up to indicate the current program number.  
Lights up when the tempo setting menu is selected  
in SETUP mode.  
SYNC OUT  
AUTO  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
TEMPO  
A.PUNCH  
Lights up when vari pitch mode is turned on.  
VARI PITCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
The VR800 displays the sampling frequency.  
If the sampling frequency of the program is different  
from the setting for the incoming signal, the indicator  
flashes. If the sampling frequency of the incoming  
S/P DIF digital signal is different from the setting,  
both [DIGITAL] and [44.1kHz] flash.  
ABS  
Indicating time base  
ABS 0 (top of the disk)  
M
S
F
PGM  
44.1kHz  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Lights up to indicate that MTC is input from an  
external MIDI device to the VR800.  
MTC IN  
LOC  
Lights up when the VR800 enters locate point (edit  
point) edit mode.  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
Display examples for time base selected via the TIME  
BASE SEL key  
When you set a digital input track in SETUP mode  
and the correct digital signal is input, the indicator  
lights up. If the signal is incorrect or the connection  
is faulty, the indicator flashes. It also flashes if no  
external digital devices are connected to the VR800.  
DIGITAL  
You can use the TIME BASE SEL key to select ABS, BAR/  
BEAT/CLK, or MTC as time base. The following examples  
show the displays when you select a time base at the  
beginning of the disk of program 1.  
Flashes when slave mode in SETUP mode is turned  
on. When a signal is locked, the flashing indicator  
lights up steadily.  
SLAVE  
M I D I  
Time base is ABS.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Lights up when the VR800 is receiving effective MIDI  
messages (MMC or FEX) from an external device.  
ABS  
M
S
F
PGM  
SCSI  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Lights up when the VR800 receives MTC (MIDI Time  
Code) from an external device.  
M T C  
%
Time base is BAR/BEAT/CLK.  
Lights up when the VR800 enters vari pitch data  
edit mode.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
BAR  
CLK  
Indicates available disk space on the disk in  
megabytes when the REMAIN indicator appears.  
MB  
PGM  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Lights up to indicate a time value whenABS or MTC  
is used as time base.  
H, M, S, F, SF  
Time base is MTC.  
Lights up to indicate a bar/beat/clock value when  
BAR/BEAT/CLK is selected as time base.  
BAR, , CLK  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
MTC  
H
M
S
F
Indicates a program title, edit parameters, and  
SETUP mode parameters.  
PGM  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Indicates the “SYNC OUT settings” in SETUP  
mode.  
SYNC OUT  
AUTO  
Indicates the AUTO PLAY/AUTO RTN mode  
settings.  
Selecting time base using the DISP SEL key  
The current drive that the VR800 recognizes (SCSI  
or ID) appears on the display. (See the following  
note.)  
When you press the DISP SEL key after you select a time  
base using the TIME BASE SEL key, the display changes as  
follows:  
DRIVE  
A.PUNCH  
Indicates the AUTO PUNCH mode settings.  
Time base is ABS.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
The indicator lights up when the digital-in clock is  
set to [ASYnC] (asynchronous). It turns off when  
the digital-in clock is set to [SYnC] (synchronous).  
The default setting is [ASYnC] (indicator on).  
ABS  
M
S
F
PGM  
SCSI  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Note: If only a SCSI drive is connected to the VR800, [SCSI]  
lights up. If an 3.5-inch internal E-IDE hard disk has been  
installed but no external SCSI device is connected as the current  
drive, [IDE] lights up. If a SCSI drive is connected, turned on,  
and specified as the current drive, and an internal hard disk is  
also connected, only [SCSI] will light up.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
MB  
REMAIN  
H
M
S
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
H
M
S
F
MTC IN  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
Time base is BAR/BEAT/CLK.  
The REMAIN display  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
The REMAIN display usually shows available recording space  
and time on the disk, calculated based on mono track recording.  
That is, it indicates how much space and time are available for  
recording on a track. Therefore, if you wish to know how much  
time is available for multiple-track recording, you need to divide  
the REMAIN value by the number of tracks you wish to record.  
The value calculation includes all data from real tracks and  
additional tracks. If some data exists on the additional tracks,  
but not on the real tracks, the space and time consumed by the  
additional tracks are considered during the calculation.  
For more information on the REMAIN display, please refer to  
“Recording method and REMAIN display” in the “Before  
Starting” chapter on page 21.  
BAR  
CLK  
PGM  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
BAR  
REMAIN  
MB  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
A.PUNCH  
AUTO  
This number indicates available recording  
space on the disk for recording on a track.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
H
M
S
F
MTC IN  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
A.PUNCH  
CLK  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
AUTO  
MB  
REMAIN  
H
M
S
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Time base is MTC.  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
MTC  
H
M
S
F
PGM  
This number indicates available recording time on the  
disk for recording on a track. For example, if you record  
on eight tracks, one-eighth of the indicated duration is  
the available recording time for each track.  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
MB  
REMAIN  
H
M
S
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
H
M
S
F
MTC IN  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Names and Functions)  
Warning messages  
The following warnings are shown operating mistakes are made, an unsuitable editing point (= locate point) is input,  
or when errors occur. If any of these warnings appear, refer to information detailed below.  
<Track Over> message  
This message appears when  
trying to record more than 2  
necessary for the selected  
DIGITAL  
<Void Data> message  
This means registered data  
DIGITAL  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
t r a c k s o f s i g n a l s  
simultaneously using a MO  
drive/disk as a Current Drive.  
SCSI  
SCSI  
operation is incorrect.  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Action to take: Re-register the correct data.  
Action to take: The MO drive only allows to record up to 2  
tracks at a time. After changing the RECORD TRACK select key  
setting, please record signals.  
DIGITAL  
<Void Out !> message  
This means the registered in/  
out point is wrong.  
DIGITAL  
<Rec + Yes !> message  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SETUP  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
This is displayed when  
formatting. This means press  
the EXECUTE/YES key while  
pressing the RECORD button.  
SURE ?  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Action to take: Re-register the correct data.  
Action to take:  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
<Select Trk> message  
This means a track has not  
been specified.  
Press the EXECUTE/YES key while pressing the RECORD button.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
<Protected> message  
DIGITAL  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
This means the disk inserted  
in the drive cannot be used  
because it is write-protected.  
The disk will be ejected  
automatically.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
Action to take: Select any one track with the RECORD TRACK  
select key.  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Action to take:  
Release the write-protect and re-insert it.  
DIGITAL  
<Over !> message  
This means there is  
insufficient disk space  
necessary for recording and  
editing.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
<Acc Error> message  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
This message indicates that  
an error occurs when  
accessing the disk. With this  
message, no keys and buttons  
do not function at all.  
Action to take: Before proceeding to the next operation,  
temporarily data in order to source empty space necessary for  
the next operation.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Action to take: If this message appears, please use the following  
procedures.  
<Load Err > message  
This means that loading is  
impossible because there is  
an error in data applied to  
the DATA IN connector from  
the external DAT, or adat.  
DIGITAL  
1. Leave the disk inside the SCSI drive and turn off the power to  
the VR800 and all connected devices.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
2. Turn on the power to the SCSI drive.  
3. Make sure that the orange LED on the SCSI drive lights up in  
green and that the disk is not being accessed. Then, turn on  
the power to the VR800.  
Action to take: Check the external DAT or adat connected to  
the DATA IN connector and be sure there is no problem with  
the DAT, or adat tape. Then, try loading again.  
<Unformat !> message  
DIGITAL  
An unformatted or crashed  
SCSI disk. After a few  
seconds of this display, the  
VR800 automatically enters  
the SETUP mode [Format ?]  
menu.  
SYNC OUT  
AUTO  
DRIVE  
A.PUNCH  
Action to take: Press the EXECUTE/YES key while pressing the  
RECORD button.  
Note: Any sound data recorded up to this point on the disk  
will be lost.  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Before Starting)  
Before Starting  
This chapter describes some basic items that you need to know before you start operating the VR800.  
All users, including those who are familiar with using tape-based multitrackers and those who are new to  
multitrackers, should read this chapter thoroughly to understand the functions of the VR800.  
1. Time Base  
2. Recording method and REMAIN indicator  
3. Managing songs by Program Change function  
4. Real tracks and Additional tracks  
5. Input monitoring and playback monitoring  
6. Audio file and Event  
Time Base  
The word “Time Base” appears frequently in this manual. The concept of Time Base is similar to a “tape counter”  
on a conventional tape-based multitracker in that it indicates the precise position of the recorder transport  
section (the current position).  
The VR800 offers three types of Time Base: ABS (Absolute type), MTC (MIDI time code), and BAR/BEAT/CLK (bar/  
beat/clock). ABS indicates an absolute time on the disk. MTC indicates a relative time that is obtained by adding  
a certain value (MTC offset value) to the ABS value. BAR/BEAT/CLK indicates the position in a song created in the  
internal Tempo Map according to MIDI clock and Song Position Pointer. The following diagrams depict the  
relationship among these three types of the Time Base.  
ABS 0  
DISK END  
00M, 00S, 00F  
00M, 08S, 00F  
REC END  
23H, 59M, 59S  
ABS  
-002 BAR, 1 , 00 CLK  
001 BAR, 1 , 00 CLK  
BAR/BEAT/CLK  
BAR = 001BAR, 0404  
TEMPO=001BAR, 1 , 60  
01H, 00M, 00S, 00F  
00H, 59M, 59S  
01H, 00M, 08S, 00F  
MTC  
MTC OFFSET=01H, 00M, 00S, 00F  
MTC OFFSET MODE=ABS  
(This shall be assumed to be the  
MTC OFFSET time set for the ABS  
00M, 00S, and 00F positions.)  
00H, 59M, 51S  
00H, 59M, 52S, 00F  
01H, 00M, 00S, 00F  
MTC  
MTC OFFSET=01H, 00M, 00S, 00F  
MTC OFFSET MODE=BAR  
(This shall be assumed to be the MTC  
non recorded area  
recorded area  
OFFSET time set for the 00 BAR, 1  
and 00 CLK positions.)  
Note: As shown in the figure, the ABS 0 position (top of  
the disk) is [-2BAR, 1BEAT, 00CLK] (Time Base - BAR/  
BEAT/CLK). You can change this position in the range of  
-9 BAR to -2 BAR in the “Setting the time signature” menu.  
Refer to the “Setting the time signature menu” section on  
page 91.  
You can switch between these three types of Time Base  
to suit your purpose. (Refer to the explanation in “Display  
Section” on page “17” for more information on switching  
Time Base.)  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Before Starting)  
Recording method and REMAIN indicator  
Recording method  
The VR800 uses a E-IDE hard disk, SCSI removable disk (such as an MO disk, zip disk etc.), or fixed disk instead  
of a cassette tape. You can start recording sound sources from any point on a formatted disk as long as the  
point is within the range of 24 hours in ABS time, as described in the previous “Time Base” section. (Refer to  
the following diagram.)  
REC END  
23H, 59M, 59S  
12M 00S 00F  
03M 00S 00F  
10M 00S 00F  
You can record at any point within 24 hours in ABS time.  
White areas are unrecorded areas.  
ABS 0  
recorded area (3 min.)  
unrecorded area  
recorded area (2 min.) unrecorded area  
You can record at any point within 24 hours in ABS time.  
The area actually used on the disk.  
recorded area (5 min.)  
unrecorded area (25 min.)  
Gray areas are recorded areas.  
recordable disk area (e.g.: 30 minutes)  
For example, if you record three minutes of data starting from ABS 0 (top of the disk) to ABS 03m 00s 00f on  
a disk that has a recordable space of thirty minutes, as shown in the diagram, then if you record two minutes  
starting at the 10-minute point in ABS time (ABS 10m 00s 00f) to ABS 12m 00s 00f, the recording end point  
(REC END) is 12 minutes (ABS 12m 00s 00f) in ABS time. However, this does not mean that the entire  
recording duration is 12 minutes. The disk space actually used for recording is five minutes (3 minutes + 2  
minutes).  
That is, the area between three minutes and ten minutes (that corresponds to 25 minutes of recording space)  
in terms of ABS time is still unrecorded.  
When you try to play or fast forward this unrecorded area, the time counter on the display will count, but the  
VR800 will not access the disk. However, MTC will be output when you try to play this area.  
On the VR800, the top of the disk is called “ABS 0” and the recording end point is called “REC END.”  
REMAIN indicator  
The REMAIN indicator displays available recording time expressed in time value (ABS or MTC) or bar/beat/  
clock (BAR/BEAT/CLI) value, depending on the currently selected Time Base. It also indicates the available  
disk space. Right after you format the disk, the REMAIN indicator will show the maximum recordable time  
and space on the disk. The following example shows that the disk had about 20 minutes or 100MB recordable  
space after the disk format operation, and has recorded data of 4 minutes 27 seconds (or 19MB).  
<Display example>  
The REMAIN indicator displays the  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
amount of unrecorded area.  
MB  
REMAIN  
H
M
S
recorded area (4 min. 27 sec./19MB)  
unrecorded area (15 min. 33 sec./81MB)  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
recordable disk area (20 min./100MB)  
The REMAIN value is calculated on a mono-track basis. That is, the value indicates available recording time  
and space if you record on one mono track.  
For example, if you wish to know how much you can record on four tracks, you need to divide the current  
REMAIN value by eight.  
The REMAIN value is also calculated by deducting the time and space of all data on the Real tracks and  
Additional tracks from the original available recording time and space. Therefore, even if there is no recording  
on Real tracks, but there is data on Additional tracks, the REMAIN time will consider the time and space used  
by the data to calculate available time and space.  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Before Starting)  
As described in “Managing the song by Program,” the VR800 can set up as many as 99 Programs on the disk.  
Setting up a Program requires a small amount of disk space. In other words, disk space is used not only for  
storing recorded data but also for storing all setup data. Therefore, make sure that you have enough space on the  
disk before you start recording to avoid running out of space (the [OVER !] message flashes in that case).  
Managing songs by Program Change function  
The VR800 features Program Select function, which enables you to set up to 99 Programs on the disk.  
When you format a disk, one Program will be automatically created on the disk. You may create more Programs,  
if necessary. You may also delete unnecessary Programs.  
The VR800 also features Program Change function that enables you to select one of the Programs set on the disk.  
Programs on the disk are something like independent containers. You can record, play, and edit each container  
without affecting other containers. You can also name Programs, which is useful for managing songs.  
program 1  
program 4  
program 7  
program 3  
program 6  
program 9  
program 2  
program 5  
program 8  
You can set up to 99 programs (independent containers).  
You can name a program.  
This example shows a “temporary title” automatically  
named to program 1 right after you format the disk.  
This indicates the number of the currently selected program.  
In this example, Program 1 selected.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
M
S
F
PGM  
SCSI  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Note: Total available recording time is always the  
Refer to page “33” for more information on the  
program select function.  
maximum available recording time on the disk,  
regardless of the number of Programs you set on the  
disk. That is, if you use up the maximum recording  
time for one Program, you will not be able to record  
any data in other Programs.  
Refer to page “34” for more information on the  
program delete function.  
Note: As described in the “REMAIN indicator,”  
creating additional Programs will consume a small  
Refer to page “35” for more information on the editing  
a program title.  
amount of disk space.  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Before Starting)  
Real tracks and Additional tracks  
The VR800 features eight Real tracks (1-8) and sixteen Additional tracks (9-24), for a total of twenty-four  
tracks. Real tracks are used to record sound sources in real-time. Additional tracks are used to temporarily  
store the sound recorded in the Real tracks. This is useful since you can move data from Real tracks to  
Additional tracks to clear tracks for fresh recording. The Track Exchange function of the VR800 handles this  
operation. This function allows you to swap data freely between twenty-four mono tracks.  
You can also swap data between multiple Real tracks and Additional tracks as an eight-track unit.  
Real tracks (Trk 1 - Trk 8)  
Additional tracks (Trk 9 - TRK 16)  
Additional tracks (Trk 17 - Trk 24)  
You can also swap data between Real tracks and  
Additional tracks in units of eight tracks.  
You can swap data between twenty-four mono tracks.  
Note: Data on the Additional tracks also affects  
the REMAIN value. If Real tracks contain no data,  
but Additional tracks contain data, the amount of  
data (time and space) will be reflected in the  
REMAIN value.  
Note: If the record time of the data existing on  
the additional track is longer than the data on the  
real track and all tracks are saved on an external  
DAT or adat, then the data of the additional track  
can only be saved for the time equal to the real  
track, and the remaining data is not saved.  
This is because the ABS 0 to REC END of the  
real track is automatically recognized and saved.  
There is a need to exchange the track using the  
track exchange function in this case, as well.  
Note: You cannot record data on Additional  
tracks in real-time. Also, you cannot play back  
data on Additional tracks as is in real-time.  
If you wish to play back data on an Additional  
track, first use the Track Exchange function to  
move the data to a Real track. Also, you need to  
move the data to a Real track if you wish to check  
the REC END point of a song on an Additional  
track.  
Refer to page “66” for more information on the Track  
Exchange function.  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Before Starting)  
Input monitoring and playback monitoring  
There are two methods for monitoring track sound (only on the Real tracks): input monitoring and playback  
monitoring. They are defined as follows:  
Input monitoring  
Input monitoring means to monitor via track output the recording signal sent to the Real tracks of the recorder.  
That is, you are monitoring a post-recorder signal, not a pre-recorder signal. The VR800 enters input monitoring  
status when you perform one of the following operations.  
• When you set a track to recording mode  
To set a track to recording mode, press the RECORD TRACK select key to set the track READY, then press the PLAY  
buttonwhile holding down the RECORD button.  
When recording starts on the READY track, the VR800 automatically enters input monitoring status.  
• When you set a track to recording stand-by mode  
To set a track to recording stand-by mode, press the RECORD TRACK select key to set the track READY, then press only  
the RECORD button. (Pressing the RECORD button again will cause the VR800 to enter playback monitoring mode.)  
Under this condition, only the READY track enters input monitoring mode, on stand-by for recording.  
* The following example shows track 5 in Input Monitoring mode and other tracks in Playback Monitoring mode.  
Track 8  
This example shows overdubbing  
in which the keyboard is recorded  
on track 5 while tracks 1-4 are  
Track 7  
Track 6  
being played. Tracks 1-4 are in  
Playback Monitoring mode and  
used to check the playback sound.  
Track 5 is in Input Monitoring mode.  
You can monitor the recorded  
sound.  
Track 5  
Mixer section  
Keyboard  
Monitoring  
section  
Track 4 (Vocal)  
Track 3 (Guitar)  
Track 2 (Bass)  
Track 1 (Drum machine)  
Recorder section  
Playback monitoring  
“Playback monitoring” means to monitor the playback sound of the tracks (only Real tracks).  
That is, you are monitoring the playback sound on the track, not the sound being recorded to the track.  
* The following example shows that all tracks are in Playback Monitoring mode.  
Track 8 (Piano)  
Track 7 (Keyboard)  
Track 6 (Vocal)  
Track 5 (Vocal)  
Monitoring  
In this example, all tracks 1-8 are playing the recorded  
Track 4 (Guitar-2)  
Track 3 (Guitar-1)  
Track 2 (Bass)  
section  
sound in Playback Monitoring mode.  
Track 1 (Drum machine)  
Recorder section  
* To play the sound on an Additional track, you need to move the data from the Additional track to a Real track. Refer to “Track Exchange  
function” on page 66 for more information.  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Before Starting)  
Audio file and event  
<About an audio file>  
During recording, the VR800 consecutively records an independent audio file (recorded area) in each  
track of each Program. However, you can record data on the VR800 at any point within 24 hours of ABS  
time, and you can intentionally create silence between two audio files. In this case, a silent part is counted  
as a 0 file.  
Therefore, audio files and 0 files are consecutively created as shown in the diagram below.  
The total number of these audio files and 0 files is called “the number of events.” The maximum number  
of events is 512 per track (tracks 1-24). After the number of events reaches 507, new data will not be  
recorded.  
ABS 0  
REC END  
Audio File 4  
Audio File 1  
Audio File 2  
Audio File 3  
0 File 1  
0 File 2  
Recorded part  
Silence  
Usually, an event is created by one recording or edit. The number of events increases or decreases depending  
on the number of edit points or the amount of disk free space. (VR800 disk management operates in such  
way that the number of events will decrease.) The number of events does not affect usual music production.  
However, if a small amount of single-track data is written in many different sections on the disk, the  
maximum number of events may be reached. To avoid this “event number overflow,” you need to check  
the number of events for each track. The VR800 provides an event check menu in Setup mode for this  
purpose.  
<Notes on digital recording>  
During S/P DIF and adat digital recording, the VR800 records “data 0” (this is called “mute recording”). When one second  
of consecutive data 0 is input to the VR800, it creates a “0 file” and limits the consumption of disk space. However, repeating  
this operation will eventually increase the number of events, leading to “event number overflow.”  
What is an event?  
As shown in the diagram below, the number of events can be eleven or more if partial recordings are made.  
This is because an unrecorded part is regarded as an event, and a recorded part is also regarded as an  
event(s). The duration of each event can vary from 740 msec to 23 hours 59 minutes 59 seconds (FS =  
44.1kHz).  
REC END  
ABS 23h 59m  
ABS 0  
0
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
10  
11  
Event Number  
Recorded part (shortest: 740 msec., FS=44.1kHz)  
Unrecorded part (shortest: 740 msec., FS=44.1kHz)  
An unrecorded part (zero file) is always regarded as one even, regardless of its duration.  
However, a recorded part can consist of a group of multiple audio file, as shown in the diagram below.  
More precisely, one audio file will be divided into multiple audio files if perform many editing operations  
(such as , copy & paste, move & paste, etc.) on this audio file. Multiple audio files created in this way are  
regarded as events. (If you do not edit the data at all, the audio file remains in one piece and is regarded  
as one event.)  
In this example, one recorded area consists of six consecutive audio files. This means that this part consists  
of six events.  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Before Starting)  
Recorded Area  
0 File  
Audio File 4  
n+4  
Audio File 6  
n+6  
0 File  
Audio File 1  
n+1  
Audio File 3  
n+3  
Audio File 5  
n+5  
Audio File 2  
n+2  
Event Number  
This is because when you perform a copy & paste, move & paste, or Auto Punch In/Out, the event is split  
at the edit point. Also, if a continuous long recording is made, the recorded data might scatter to different  
locations on the hard disk, thus dividing the data unto multiple events.  
CLIPBOARD IN point  
CLIPBOARD OUT point  
0 File  
Audio File 4  
n+4  
Audio File 6  
n+6  
0 File  
Audio File 1  
n+1  
Audio File 3  
n+3  
Audio File 5  
n+5  
Audio File 2  
n+2  
Event Number  
Countermeasures against accumulating too many events due to a long recording plus many editing  
operations:  
One solution is to save and re-load the data to and from a DAT, adat, or SCSI device. (If the song is too long,  
you may not be able to save the data to a DAT or adat.)  
In this way, multiple consecutive audio files are optimized into one continuous audio file in some cases.  
Set the Clipboard In point and the Clipboard Out points within an unrecorded range to copy the area (the  
area that contains multiple audio files and you wish to optimize) between them, then paste the data  
starting from the same Clipboard In point. Multiple audio files within this range will become a single audio  
file.  
<Hints>  
Make sure that you set the Clipboard In/Out points within zero files, and that you paste the area starting  
from the same Clipboard In point.  
* In any case, bear in mind that you cannot reduce the excessive number of events if the target range  
contains a zero file.  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Formatting a Disk)  
Formatting a Disk  
The “Quick Operation Guide” and the “Saving and Loading Song Data” chapter of this book describe how to  
format a disk. This chapter explains how to format an unformatted disk and how to re-format a formatted disk.  
Formatting a disk refers to both formatting the current drive disk and formatting a backup disk. You will use the  
[Format ?] and the [Bk Format?] menus in Setup Mode.  
Recording mode  
There are four recording Modes: “Master 8ch” mode, “Master 4ch” mode, “ADAC 8ch” mode, and “Backup”  
mode. Master 8ch mode, Master 4ch mode and ADAC 8ch mode are used to format a disk as the current drive  
disk. Backup mode is used to format a SCSI disk (removable or fixed) for saving and loading song data.  
For use  
Recording mode for current drive  
Recording mode for backup  
Backup mode  
ADAC 8ch mode  
44.1kHz  
Master 8ch mode  
44.1kHz  
Master 4ch mode  
44.1kHz  
Record mode  
Sampling Rate  
Quantumize  
44.1kHz  
A.D.A.C. (*)  
16bit liner  
16bit liner  
Approx. 67 minutes/100MB  
(converted to one track)  
Approx. 17 minutes/100MB  
(converted to one track)  
Approx. 17 minutes/100MB  
(converted to one track)  
Available recording time  
MO disk, Zip cartridge,  
Fixed hard disk,  
MO disk, Zip cartridge,  
Fixed hard disk,  
MO disk, Zip cartridge,  
Fixed hard disk,  
Fixed hard disk,  
Compatible media  
3.5 inch E-IDE hard disk  
3.5 inch E-IDE hard disk  
3.5 inch E-IDE hard disk  
DVD RAM disk  
* Simultaneous 8 track recording  
by adat digital input is possible.  
* Simultaneous 8 track recording  
by adat digital input is possible.  
This is a special backup disk  
format for saving and loading  
data. You cannot use a disk in  
this format for real-time  
recording/playback.  
* Simultaneous 4 track recording  
by adat digital input is possible.  
(ch1~ch4)  
Record function  
Note: Simultaneous recording by  
MO disk is a maximum two tracks.  
Note: Simultaneous recording by  
MO disk is a maximum two tracks.  
Save/load is possible only with  
external SCSI drive and DAT.  
Save/load is not possible with  
adat.  
Save/load is possible only with Save/load is possible only with  
external SCSI drives. external SCSI drive, DAT or  
Save/load is not possible with DAT adat.  
and adat.  
You can save and load data  
between the backup disk and a  
current drive disk formatted in  
any mode.  
Save/Load function  
(*) A.D.A.C. is the next generation digital audio coding technique maximized for multitrack recording, which has been developed by joint research of Matsushita Electric  
Industry Corporation and Fostex Corporation.  
Note: Available recording time varies depending on the disk capacity and type. For actual available time for a particular disk,  
please refer to the “List of the drives with guaranteed operation” in the Owner’s Manual.  
Note: You cannot save programs in different formats to the same back-up disk. Be aware of this when you are using a fixed  
disk as the back-up disk.  
Note: You can format a fixed disk or a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk with any ID number other than “6” in [Master 8ch] mode. If  
you are using a removable SCSI disk as the current drive, format it in [Master 4ch] mode or [ADAC 8ch] mode. Formatting  
a removable SCSI disk in [Master 8ch] mode will not provide enough recordable space.  
Note that data recorded on a disk formatted in [ADAC 8ch] mode cannot be saved or loaded using a DAT or adat. Only the  
data recorded on the [Master 8ch] mode disk can be saved or loaded to/from a DAT or adat.  
Set the ID number of a SCSI drive (fixed or removable) that will be used as a back-up disk to “6.” When you use the [Format  
?] menu in SETUP mode, the VR800 recognizes SCSI drives or 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disks with any ID number other than  
“6.” When you use the [Bk Format ?] menu, the VR800 automatically recognizes SCSI drives with the ID number “6.”  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Formatting a Disk)  
Formatting a current drive disk (SCSI disk)  
The VR800 supports SCSI removable and fixed disks and 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disks as the current drive. This section  
explains how to format a SCSI removable (or fixed) disk. To format a SCSI disk, the [SCSI] indicator in the [DRIVE]  
section of the display should be lit. If a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk is also connected, make sure that the [SCSI] indicator  
is lit as shown below.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
ABS  
M
S
F
M
S
F
PGM  
SCSI  
PGM  
SCSI  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SYNC OUT  
AUTO  
DRIVE  
[SCSI] is lights up  
[SCSI] is lights up  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
A.PUNCH  
<The display when disk is set in the current drive.>  
<The display when no disk is set in the current drive.>  
Formatting a new disk  
The following procedure explains how to format a new SCSI disk, and assumes that a SCSI drive (removable or  
fixed hard disk) is connected to the VR800 as the current drive.  
5. Press and hold the RECORD button and press the  
1. Turn on the power to the VR800 and the current  
EXECUTE/YES key.  
drive.  
The VR800 starts formatting in selected recording mode.  
[REMAIN] lights up on the display, and a negative value  
of the unformatted disk area size will count down as the  
format operation progresses. Please wait a while.  
When formatting is complete, [COMPLETED !] lights up  
on the display, and the VR800 stops spinning the disk.  
The [Initial...] message, then [No Disk] message appears  
on the display. (If a fixed hard disk is connected, the  
[Initial...] message, then the [Un Format !] message ap-  
pears and the VR800 enters SETUP mode. Skip to Step 3  
below.)  
2. Insert a new removable disk into the current drive.  
The VR800 displays the “UnFormat!” message, then au-  
tomatically enters SETUP mode, and displays the “For-  
mat ?” menu. At this time, the ID number (e.g., [ID-2])  
of the connected SCSI drive (or fixed disk) will appear  
and [SURE ?] will blink on the display.  
Press the EXIT/NO key or the STOP button to exit  
SETUP mode.  
6.  
Formatting will automatically create one Program 1 on  
the disk. The Time Base will change to ABS 0.  
7. Press the DISP SEL key to change to the REMAIN  
display and check the available recording time.  
Press the DISP SEL key again to return to the Time Base  
display.  
3. Make sure that the ID number is correct and the  
[SURE ?] message appears, then press the EX-  
ECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 displays [Pls Wait !], then immediately dis-  
plays the recording mode menu, with [ADAC 8ch] (ADAC  
8ch mode) and [SURE ?] flashing.  
Press the EXIT/NO key while holding down the SHIFT  
key to eject the removable disk from the drive.  
Turn the JOG dial to select the desired recording  
mode.  
4.  
Turn the JOG dial to select [ADAC 8ch], [Master 8ch], or  
If you wish to format another removable disk, insert the  
disk and repeat the procedure described above.  
[Master 4ch], according to the media or your application.  
Note: If you are using a removable MO or Zip disk as the  
current drive, select [ADAC 8ch] or [Master 4ch].  
Note that you cannot save or load data via a DAT or adat if  
you recorded the data on a disk formatted in [ADAC 8ch]  
mode.  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Formatting a Disk)  
Re-formatting a formatted disk  
This section explains how to re-format a current drive or backup disk as the current disk.  
You need to use the [Format ?] menu in SETUP mode to reformat a disk. In the following procedure, we assume  
that a SCSI drive is connected to the VR800 and that the power to the VR800 and the SCSI drive is turned on. (The  
same procedure also applies to a fixed disk or 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk.)  
5. Use the JOG dial to select the desired recording  
1. Insert a formatted disk into the SCSI drive.  
mode. Press and hold down the RECORD button  
and press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 displays the recording mode of the disk  
(ADAC 8ch, Master 8ch, or Master 4ch), then displays  
ABS 0 of Program 1. If you are using a disk formatted  
for backup, the VR800 displays [Bk Format], then the  
Time Base indication.  
The VR800 starts formatting the disk in selected record-  
ing mode.  
[REMAIN] lights up on the display, and the negative value  
of the unformatted disk area size will count down as the  
format operation progresses. Please wait a while.  
When formatting is complete, [COMPLETED !] lights up  
on the display, and the VR800 stops spinning the disk.  
Press the SETUP key to enter SETUP mode and  
2.  
turn the JOG dial to select [Format ?].  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
6. Press the EXIT/NO key or the STOP button to exit  
The ID number of the connected SCSI drive appears and  
[SURE ?] flashes on the display.  
SETUP mode.  
Formatting will automatically create one Program 1 on  
the disk, and the Time Base will change to ABS 0.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key again.  
Turn the JOG dial to select [ADAC 8ch], [Master 8ch], or  
[Master 4ch], according to the media or your application.  
7. Press the DISP SEL key to change to the REMAIN  
display and check the available recording time.  
Press the DISP SEL key again to return to the Time Base  
display.  
Note: Before re-formatting a formatted disk, first make sure that the disk does not contain data you want to keep. Otherwise,  
you may lose your important archives.  
To cancel the format operation, press the EXIT/NO key or the STOP button prior to Step 5 above to return to the previous level  
in the menu hierarchy and exit SETUP mode.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
<Notes on re-formatting a disk>  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
When you re-format a backup disk to be a current drive disk, insert-  
ing the disk in the current drive displays [Bk Format] followed by the  
ABS 0 Time Base.  
Although the ABS 0 Time Base appears, the disk cannot be used in  
its present condition as the current drive disk to perform real-time  
playback/recording.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
M
S
F
PGM  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Formatting a Disk)  
Formatting a current drive disk (3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk)  
When you format or re-format a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk, make sure that the [IDE] indicator is lit in the [DRIVE] section  
of the display (see the “Note” below) and follow the steps explained in the “Formatting a SCSI drive” and “Re-formatting  
a SCSI drive” sections.  
<Note on formatting an 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk>  
The [IDE] indicator appears on the display if you turn on the power to the  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
VR800 under the following circumstances:  
ABS  
M
S
F
- when only the 3.5-inch hard disk is connected, or  
- when both SCSI and E-IDE disks are connected but only the E-IDE disk  
is turned on.  
PGM  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
This means that the VR800 recognizes the 3.5-inch hard disk as the current  
drive. Before formatting a connected 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk, make sure  
that the [IDE] indicator is lit.  
[IDE] lights up  
Formatting a backup disk (SCSI disk)  
Song data you recorded in the current drive (SCSI drive, fixed disk, or 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk) can be saved to  
a backup SCSI drive disk, as well as a DAT or adat, and can be re-loaded later. To use a backup SCSI drive, you  
need to set the SCSI ID number of the backup drive to “6” and format it in backup recording mode.  
The VR800 does not indicate the connected backup disk on the display (unlike the current drive). You need to  
use [Bk Format?] menu in SETUP mode to format a backup disk while the current drive is on. However, if the disk  
has not yet been formatted, you may format it during the save/load operation.  
For more information on formatting an unformatted disk for saving and loading song data, refer to “Saving and  
Loading Song Data” on page 75.  
The following procedure assumes that a current drive (SCSI drive, fixed disk, or 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk) is  
connected to the VR800, and a Program on the current drive disk is selected.  
Formatting an unformatted disk for backup  
This procedure enables you to format a new disk for backup, and assumes that a disk has been installed in the current  
drive.  
4. Press and hold the RECORD button and press the  
1. Insert a new disk into the backup drive.  
The display remains showing the Time Base indication  
for the current drive disk.  
EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 starts formatting  
[REMAIN] lights up on the display, and the negative value  
of the unformatted disk area size will count down as the  
format operation progresses. Please wait a while.  
When formatting is complete, [COMPLETED !] lights up  
on the display, and the VR800 stops spinning the disk.  
At the same time, the VR800 shows the maximum re-  
cordable space. (To check the REMAIN time and space,  
refer to the next page following <Memo>.)  
2. Press the SETUP key to enter SETUP mode, and  
turn the JOG dial to select the [Bk Format ?] menu.  
Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
3.  
The VR800 displays [UnFormat] and [SURE?] flashes.  
This means that the disk with the ID number “6” is ready  
for formatting.  
5. Press the EXIT/NO key or the STOP button.  
If you turn the JOG dial, [Eject] appears, and pressing  
the EXECUTE/YES key will eject the disk.  
The display will change from the REMAIN indication for  
the backup disk to the Time Base indication for the cur-  
rent drive.  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Formatting a Disk)  
<Memo>  
To check the REMAIN time for the backup disk after formatting it, eject the disk, then replace it with the disk in the current  
drive. Then press the DISP SEL key to show the REMAIN display. You can check the REMAIN time of the backup disk in  
this way. However, you cannot perform another operation using the backup disk at this time. Attempting to do so will cause  
the VR800 to display [Viod Cmd! (Void Command!)] and ignore your operation.  
To eject the disk from the backup drive or the current drive after the format operation, follow the procedure below:  
* To eject a disk from the backup drive: Press the Eject button on the drive.  
* To eject a disk from the current drive: Press and hold the SHIFT key and press the EXIT/NO key.  
Re-formatting a formatted disk for backup  
This section explains how to re-format a backup or current drive disk as a backup disk.  
The following procedure assumes that a disk has been installed in the current drive.  
4. Press and hold the RECORD button and press the  
Insert a formatted disk into the backup drive.  
The display continues to show the Time Base for the cur-  
rent drive.  
1.  
EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 starts formatting.  
[REMAIN] lights up on the display, and the negative value  
of the unformatted disk area will count down as the for-  
mat operation progresses. Please wait a while.  
When formatting is complete, [COMPLETED !] lights up  
on the display, and the VR800 stops spinning the disk.  
At the same time, the VR800 shows the maximum re-  
cordable space. (To check the REMAIN time and space,  
refer to the <Memo> on the previous page.)  
2. Press the SETUP key to enter SETUP mode, and  
turn the JOG dial to select the [Bk Format ?] menu.  
Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
3.  
The VR800 displays the recording mode that corresponds  
to the disk format. The [SURE ?] message flashes.  
A different message appears depending on the type of  
format used by the disk as shown below.  
5. Press the EXIT/NO key or the STOP button.  
If you turn the JOG dial, [Eject] appears, and pressing  
the EXECUTE/YES key ejects the disk.  
The display will change from the REMAIN indication for  
the backup disk to the Time Base indication for the cur-  
rent drive.  
Type of format  
Backup mode  
ADAC 8ch mode  
Master 8ch mode  
Master 4ch mode  
Others  
Message  
[Bk Format]  
[ADAC 8ch]  
[Master 8ch]  
[Master 4ch]  
[Un Format]  
Note: Before re-formatting a formatted disk, first make sure that the disk does not contain data that you want to keep.  
Otherwise, you may lose your important archives.  
To cancel the format operation, press the EXIT/NO key or the STOP button prior to Step 4 above to return to the previous  
level in the menu hierarchy and exit SETUP mode.  
Formatting a backup disk (fixed disk)  
You can also use a fixed disk by setting its ID number to “6.”  
The formatting procedure described above also applies to formatting a fixed disk as a backup disk.  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Handling Programs)  
Handling Programs  
This chapter explains how to handle Programs. It covers the following topics:  
1. Creating a new Program  
2. Using a Program Change function  
3. Deleting a Program  
4. Editing a Program title  
Creating a new Program  
You can manage individual songs by setting multiple programs on the disk as explained in the “Managing songs  
by program change function” section of the “Before Starting” chapter. Up to 99 programs can be created as long  
as disk space is available. When you format a disk, one program will be automatically created. Follow the steps  
below to create a new program (in addition to the Program created on the disk during the format operation).  
1 (Turn on the power)  
3. While holding down the HOLD/> key, press the  
STORE key.  
[Select PGM] appears on the display briefly, then changes  
to a flashing “01” ([#0001 of PGM 01) and [SURE?] flash.  
([#0001] is the default name of PGM 01.)  
OPTICAL  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
2
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
SURE ?  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
CLK  
SCSI  
RECORD TRACK  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
4. Turn the JOG dial clockwise.  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
5, 6, 7  
8
PGM SEL  
The question marks “?” of [New PGM ?] and [SURE?] flash.  
This indication asks you if you wish to set a new program  
(program 2).  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
SURE  
?
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
4
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
5. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
3
The VR800 will automatically enter [Title Edit ?] menu in  
SETUP mode. You can enter a title for program 2. ([t] and  
[?]flash alternately.)  
1. Turn on the power to the VR800 and a connected  
SCSI drive.  
If you prefer the default name, press the EXIT/NO key.  
2. Insert a formatted disk into the SCSI drive.  
The VR800 will display [Initial..], [(SCSI drive name and  
ID number)], [(Recording mode, such as [ADAC 8ch])],  
then the top of ABS time base (ABS 0).  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
PGM  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
The current program is [PGM 01]. [#0001] is the default  
name of PGM 01.  
6. Press the EXECUTE/YES key again.  
A default title (#0002) appears on the display, with [#]  
and [SURE?] flashing. This means that you can enter a  
name for the new program.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
M
S
F
PGM  
SCSI  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
If you wish to name the program, continue the steps below.  
In either case, you can change the title later, as explained  
in “Editing a program title.”  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Handling Programs)  
7. When you finish entering the title, press the  
EXECUTE/YES key.  
To enter a title:  
• Turning the JOG dial will enter a character or number  
at the location of the flashing cursor. You can enter  
up to 16 characters, nine of which will appear on the  
display.  
Program 2 (PGM 02) and its title are set.  
The display shows the ABS time base indication of the  
program.  
• To move the flashing cursor, press the HOLD/> key,  
the REWIND button, or the F FWD button. The F FWD  
button is the most convenient.  
<Important!>  
• Whenever you create a new program by selecting the [New PGM  
?] menu, a new program is created with an increment number.  
That is, if only one program exists, the next one will be named  
program 2.  
• You can enter the following characters and numbers:  
If programs 1-5 already exist, the new program number will be 6.  
• If there is insufficient recording space on the disk, you cannot  
create the new program. Each time you create a new program,  
the recordable area on the disk will decrease.  
Using a Program Change function  
If multiple programs exist on the disk, you need to select a program to record, play, or edit. This section  
describes how to select a program.  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Note: You cannot use the program change function if the VR800  
is in SETUP mode.  
SURE ?  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
1
2. Turn the JOG dial to select the desired program  
number (flashing).  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
Rotating the JOG dial counter-clockwise decreases the  
number. Rotating it clockwise increases the number.  
If you turn the JOG dial clockwise all the way, [New PGM?]  
will be selected. Select [New PGM ?] to create a new  
program as mentioned in the previous section.  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
NO  
EXECUTE  
YES  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
/
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
3
2
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
For example, you can select one of seven programs as  
follows:  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
PGM 05  
New PGM  
PGM 02 PGM 03 PGM 04  
PGM 06 PGM 07  
PGM 01  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
You can select from PGM 03 up to  
New PGM in this direction.  
You can select up to PGM  
01 in this direction.  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The ABS time base indication for the selected program  
appears. In this way, you can be sure to select a program  
before you start working.  
1. When the VR800 is stopped, press the STORE key  
while holding down the HOLD/> key.  
[Select PGM] will appear on the display briefly, and then  
change to a flashing “01” ([#0001 of PGM 01) and [SURE?]  
flash. ([#0001] is the default name of PGM 01.)  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Handling Programs)  
Deleting a Program  
This section explains how to delete a program.  
Deleting an unnecessary program will expand the recordable area, making your work flow more smoothly, since  
recording or editing requires free space on the disk. Use the [Del. PGM ?] menu in SETUP mode to delete a  
program.  
1. Press the SETUP key while the VR800 is stopped.  
<Notes on deleting a Program>  
The VR800 will enter the SETUP mode, and display the  
first hierarchy of the SETUP menu that was displayed  
before you turned off the power.  
• You can delete only the currently-selected program. Refer to the  
previous section, “Using a program change function,” for information  
on how to select the desired program before you proceed to delete  
the program.  
The default setting is [Sign. Set ?] menu (setting a time  
signature).  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
• <IMPORTANT> If only one program exists and you try to delete it,  
data contained in the program will be deleted, but the program itself  
will remain. For example, assume that PGM 01 -07 exist and you  
try to delete PGM 05. Program number 05 will remain, but the data  
inside PGM 05 will be replaced with the data of PGM 06.  
The subsequent programs’ data will move in the same way.  
Therefore, it will appear that PGM 07 has been deleted.  
If you delete the last program (PGM 07 in this example), PGM 07  
will be completely deleted.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select the first hierarchy of the  
[Del. PGM ?] (deleting a Program) menu.  
Or, you can use the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or  
the F FWD button.  
PGM 05  
PGM 02 PGM 03 PGM 04  
PGM 06 PGM 07  
PGM 01  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
If you try to deleted PGM 05, only the  
data of PGM 05 will be deleted and  
the data of PGM 06 will move into  
PGM 05.  
PGM  
After deleted  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
PGM 05  
PGM 02 PGM 03 PGM 04  
PGM 06  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
PGM 01  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
Note: You cannot use the Undo/Redo function to delete  
programs. Make sure that you delete the correct  
program.  
The number of the program to be deleted appears and  
[SURE ?] flashes.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
PGM  
SURE ?  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
To cancel the delete operation, press the EXIT/NO key while  
[SURE ?] is flashing. Each time you press the button or key, the  
VR800 will return to a higher level in the hierarchy, and finally exit  
the SETUP mode.  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
3, 4  
1
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
NO  
EXECUTE  
YES  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
/
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key again.  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
When the VR800 displays [Deleting...] and finishes  
deleting the program, the data of the next program  
number moves in, and its ABS time appears.  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
2
To check the REMAIN time and free space, press the DISP SEL  
key to display the [REMAIN] indication after the program is deleted.  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Handling Programs)  
Editing a Program title  
You can name the program as explained in the “Creating a new program” section. You can also change the title  
later by using the [Title Edit ?] menu in SETUP mode.  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
Note: You can edit the title of the selected program before you  
The currently-selected program title will appear with the  
left-most character flashing.  
select SETUP mode. You cannot select a program after the VR800  
enters SETUP mode. Be sure to select the desired program using  
the steps explained in the “Using the program change function”  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
section.  
1
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
4. Press the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or the  
F FWD button to move the flashing cursor, and use  
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
the JOG dial to enter characters or numbers.  
To move the flashing cursor, press the HOLD/> key, the  
REWIND button, or the F FWD button. The F FWD button  
is the most convenient.  
3, 5  
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
NO  
EXECUTE  
YES  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
/
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
You can enter up to 16 characters, nine of which will  
appear on the display.  
You may enter the following characters and numbers:  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
4
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
6
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
2, 4  
0
4
4
1. Press the SETUP key while the VR800 is stopped.  
The VR800 will enter the SETUP mode and display the  
first hierarchy level of the SETUP menu that was selected  
before you turned off the power.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
5. After you enter the title, press the EXECUTE/YES  
SETUP  
key.  
The new title will be confirmed, and the ABS time value  
of the program will appears.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select the first hierarchy level  
of the [Title Edit ?] menu.  
The symbols [t] and [?] will flash alternately.  
The currently-selected program number will also appears.  
You can also use the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or  
the F FWD button to select the first hierarchy level  
display.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
PGM  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s manual (Punch In/Out Recording)  
Punch In/Out Recording  
What is Punch In/Out recording?  
Punch In/Out recording enables you to record over previously-recorded parts. See the diagram below.  
For example, using the Punch In/Out function allows you to change an unsatisfactory guitar solo.  
The VR800 offers two types of Punch In/Out functions. One is called Auto Punch In/Out, in which you automatically  
re-record a specified part. The other is called Manual Punch In/Out, in which you record data manually (using  
your foot to operate an optional foot switch, model 8051).  
Both functions feature “Rehearsal mode” to enable you to practice repeatedly until you are ready.  
Punch In point  
Punch Out point  
• Select a Program for Punch In/Out recording.  
• Initialize the VR800.  
Track 8  
Track 7  
Track 6  
Note: You can use the Punch In/Out recording only for  
Real tracks 1-8. If you wish to use Punch In/Out recording  
for data on an Additional track, first move the data to the  
Real tracks.  
Track 5  
Track 4  
Track 3  
Track 2  
Track 1  
This part is changed.  
Auto Punch In/Out  
To perform Auto Punch In/Out recording, you need to specify the Auto Punch In point (recording start point)  
and the Auto Punch Out point (recording end point).  
Preparation  
Previewing and trimming the edit points  
Storing the edit points  
You can check the stored edit points by pressing the  
corresponding memory keys to display them on the LCD.  
You can also change the points if necessary.  
1. Refer to “Storing the edit points” to set the Auto  
Punch In/Out points.  
Store the Auto Punch In point to the AUTO PUNCH IN  
key, and the Auto Punch Out point to the AUTO PUNCH  
OUT key.  
In this example, use the Preview function to fine-tune the  
point while previewing.  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, hold down the SHIFT  
key and press the memory key.  
• Refer to page “48” for more information on storing the edit points.  
Pressing the AUTO PUNCH IN key enables you to listen to  
the sound at the AUTO PUNCH IN point (“previewing the  
sound rise [fade-out]”). Pressing the AUTO PUNCH OUT  
key enables you to listen to the sound at the AUTO PUNCH  
OUT point (“previewing the sound fall [fade-in]”).  
Note: Make sure that you specify an Auto Punch In point that  
precedes the Auto Punch Out point. If the Auto Punch Out point  
precedes the Auto Punch In point, [Void Out !] appears and  
you will be unable to perform Auto Punch In/Out recording.  
2. Trim the edit point while auditioning the sound.  
• Refer to page “59” for more information on the Preview function.  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Punch In/Out Recording)  
When you finish storing and adjusting the respective edit points, you can proceed to the Auto Punch In/Out  
operations. In this example, we will re-record part of the guitar phrase on track 3, chosen from all the recordings  
on tracks 1-8. Prior to proceeding with this operation, check to see that an external digiral mixer is connected to  
VR800 as shown in the figure. then confirm that the guitar to record on track 3 is connected to the input jack of  
the digital mixer.  
DATA IN  
WORD OUT  
DATA OUT  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
OPTICAL IN (adat IN)  
OPTICAL OUT (adat OUT)  
WORD IN  
METER  
OL  
-3  
-6  
-9  
-12  
-18  
-24  
-36  
-40  
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO  
PAGE SELECT  
9-16 ADAT IN  
1-8 ANALOG IN  
17-20 EFF RTN  
SETUP  
EQ/LO  
GAIN  
EQ/LO-MID  
GAIN  
EQ/HI-MID  
GAIN  
EQ/HI  
GAIN  
SELECTED EQ  
EQ ON  
EFF EDIT  
SYSTEM  
MIDI  
EFF1  
EFF2  
EQ LIBRARY  
EFF LIBRARY  
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS  
RECALL  
STORE  
RECALL  
STORE  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
SOLO  
ON  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
KEY MODE  
ROUTING/  
PHASE  
PAIR/  
GROUP  
REC BUSS  
SOLO  
SCENE MEMORY  
RECALL STORE  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
MMC SEND  
CHANNEL/  
METER  
CH VIEW  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
/-1  
+1/  
EXIT  
DATA  
+10  
0
+10  
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
+10  
0
+10  
0
0
0
-10  
-20  
0
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-30  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
ENTER  
-20  
-40  
-60  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Digital Mixer  
Music instrument (Guitar)  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s manual (Punch In/Out Recording)  
Rehearsing Auto Punch In/Out recording  
In Rehearsal mode, the READY track assumes input monitoring mode between the Auto Punch In and Out points,  
and the sound is not recorded. You can practice Auto Punch In/Out operation repeatedly before you proceed to  
actual recording. Locate the recording start position slightly before the Auto Punch In point.  
<Tips for rehearsal>  
5. When you are satisfied with your rehearsal, press  
the STOP button.  
Set the preroll value while referring to the “Changing the Initial  
Settings (SETUP Mode)” chapter. In this way, the VR800 can locate  
a point that precedes the Auto Punch In point by the specified preroll  
value. This enables you to start playback slightly before the Punch  
In point. (Refer to page 94 for more information on “Changing the  
Initial Settings.”) The VR800 will repeat playback data between the  
AUTO RTN START point and the AUTO RTN END point if you set  
the AUTO RTN START point before the Auto Punch In point and  
the AUTO RTN END point after the Auto Punch Out point. This  
allows you to repeat rehearsal. See the “Hint-2.”.  
<Hint 1>  
Locating a point slightly before the Auto Punch In point  
To locate the playback start point for rehearsal, press the AUTO  
PUNCH IN key, then press the LOCATE key.  
The VR800 displays the time (position) stored in the AUTO PUNCH  
IN key, and locates the point and stops.  
Press the REWIND button to go backward. If you have set the preroll  
time as described on page “94,” you can locate a point that precedes  
the Auto Punch In point by the specified preroll value.  
1. Press the RECORD button while holding down the  
SHIFT key.  
Auto Punch In point  
Stop here.  
Auto Punch Out point  
The [RHSL] indicator flashes in the A.PUNCH mode  
indication area of the display. This means that Auto Punch  
mode in turned on.  
A.PUNCH  
Flashes  
RHSL  
Locate  
Locate  
2. Set the track for Auto Punch In/Out to READY.  
Press the RECORD RACK select key [3] to set track 3 to  
READY.  
The VR800 stops at a point that precedes the Auto  
Punch In point by the specified preroll time. (0 - 10  
seconds)  
3. Start playback of the VR800 from a point slightly  
<Hint 2>  
before the Auto Punch In point.  
The VR800 operates as shown in the figure below during  
rehearsal operations.  
Quick and easy operation for repeated rehearsal  
Using the Auto Return function and the Auto Play function enables  
you to rehearse repeatedly.  
As shown below, set the AUTO RTN START and END points for  
Auto Return and Auto Play. In this way, you can repeat rehearsal  
easily, while checking the recording level and concentrating on your  
performance.  
Auto Punch Out point  
(Rehearsal Out)  
Auto Punch In point  
(Rehearsal In)  
Playback  
end point  
Playback  
start point  
Track 8  
Refer to page “48” for more information on setting the AUTO RTN  
START/END points.  
Track 7  
Track 6  
Track 5  
Track 4  
Track 3  
Track 2  
Track 1  
Auto Punch Out point  
Auto Return End point  
Auto Punch In point  
Auto Return Start point  
This part is changed.  
Rehearsal area  
Only track 3 in input monitor-  
ing. The sound is not recorded  
at this time. The RECORD  
button lamp flashes.  
All tracks are in playback  
monitoring mode.  
All tracks are in playback  
monitoring mode.  
Playback starts from the Auto Return Start  
point, and you can rehearse Auto Punch In/  
Out.  
When the Auto Return End point is reached, the  
VR800 locates the Auto Return Start point.  
The VR800 punches in  
automatically at the  
Punch In point.  
The VR800 punches  
out automatically at the  
Punch Out point.  
4. Play the guitar accompanying the playback sound  
from tracks 1 - 8 for rehearsal, while adjusting the  
Note: If the VR800 display [Over!] when you turn on Auto  
Punch mode, the disk does not have enough free space for  
Auto Punch In/Out. You need to erase part of the Program  
data, then try again.  
recording level.  
You will hear the guitar performance between the Auto  
Punch In and Out points. Otherwise, you will hear the  
recorded guitar sound.  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Punch In/Out Recording)  
Auto Punch In/Out Take  
After you are satisfied with your rehearsal, you can proceed to an actual take of Auto Punch In/Out.  
You can undo or redo Auto Punch In/Out recording if you change your mind. The control panel settings are the  
same as those for rehearsal.  
1. Press the RECORD TRACK select key [3] to set  
• The lamp of RECORD TRACK select key will only light up  
between the AUTO PUNCH IN/OUT point, and will flash in  
track 3 to READY.  
any other case.  
2. Locate a point slightly before the Auto Punch In  
point.  
• When the Auto Punch Out point is passed, the VR800  
cancels Auto Punch mode automatically, and nothing  
appears in the A. PUNCH display area.  
3. Confirm that Auto Punch mode is turned on.  
Press the RECORD button while holding down the SHIFT  
key to turn on the function, if it is not already on.  
<Caution after Punch Out>  
At “Take” of punch out, the punch-in recording track will not  
immediately enter the repro monitor mode from the input  
monitor mode enter the repro monitor mode about two  
seconds after mute playback. This is a functional feature of  
VR800 and not a malfunction.  
4. Press the RECORD button while holding down the  
PLAY button.  
The flashing [RHSL] on the display changes to an  
illuminated [TAKE], and recording starts.  
A.PUNCH  
Lights up  
TAKE  
5. When you finish recording, press the STOP button.  
The VR800 operates as follows.  
6. Play track 3 to check the result of the Auto Punch  
In/Out operation.  
Playback  
start point  
Auto Punch In point  
(Take In)  
Auto Punch Out point  
(Take Out)  
Playback  
end point  
If you fail with AUTO PUNCH IN/OUT and are not satisfied,  
repeat the process by performing the AUTO PUNCH IN/  
OUT undo operations described in the next section.  
Track 8  
Track 7  
Track 6  
Track 5  
Track 4  
Track 3  
Track 2  
Track 1  
This part is changed.  
Only track 3 in input  
monitoring, and data will be  
recorded.  
All tracks are in playback  
monitoring mode.  
All tracks are in playback  
monitoring mode.  
The RECORD button lamp  
lights up in this area.  
The VR800 punches in auto-  
matically at the Auto Punch In  
point.  
The VR800 punches out auto-  
matically at theAuto Punch Out  
point.  
Undo/Redo Auto Punch In/Out recording  
You can undo or redo Auto Punch In/Out recording.  
Press the UNDO/REDO key after recording is complete to restore the conditions that existed prior to the recording.  
Press the UNDO/REDO key again to restore the conditions that existed after the recording.  
Follow the notes below:  
Note-1: The Undo/Redo function is effective only when the VR800 is stopped.  
Note-2: The Undo/Redo is not effective if you perform one of the following operations after you finish recording:  
• When a new recording is made.  
• While a new editing is executed (such as Copy & Paste, Move & Paste, or Erase).  
• When in the AUTO PUNCH ON mode, when the AUTO PUNCH IN point is passed in the PLAY (or RECORD) mode.  
• When the power is momentarily switched off.  
• When the program is changed.  
• When ejecting a removable SCSI disk that is the current drive.  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s manual (Punch In/Out Recording)  
Manual Punch In/Out  
This section explains how to perform Manual Punch In/Out using a foot switch (optional Model 8051).  
You do not need to specify the Punch In/Out points. Instead, you press the foot switch at the Punch In/Out point.  
Manual Punch In/Out also offers rehearsal and actual takes. You can repeat rehearsal until you are ready.  
As an example, replace a part of the recorded guitar solo on track 3.  
• Initialize the VR800.  
• Select a desired Program for Punch In/Out.  
Preparation  
Check to see that the guitar is connected to the input jack of the mixer, as required for [AUTO PUNCH IN/OUT]  
mentioned earlier.  
Connect an optional foot switch (Model 8051) to the PUNCH IN/OUT jack on the side panel.  
PUNCH IN/OUT jack  
Model 8051 Foot switch  
Rehearsing Manual Punch In/Out recording  
In Rehearsal mode, the READY track enters input monitoring mode between the Punch In and Out points (the  
points at which you press the foot switch), and the sound is not recorded. You can practice the Punch In/Out  
operation repeatedly before you proceed to actual recording.  
1. Press the foot switch while holding down the STOP  
4. Play the guitar accompanying the playback of tracks  
button.  
1 to 8.  
[Rehearsal On] will appear on the display dor about 1  
second, then rehearsal mode will appear and the [RHSL]  
flashes in the A. PUNCH display.  
The recording level and monitor volume is adjusted on  
the mixer in the same manner as done for [AUTO PUNCH  
IN/OUT] descrived earlier.  
5. Press the foot switch once at the desired Punch In  
point, then press the foot switch again at the desired  
A.PUNCH  
RHSL  
Flashes  
Punch Out point.  
2. Press the RECORD TRACK select key [3] to set  
track 3 to READY.  
The rehearsal mode will operate as shown in the figure.  
Between the Punch In and Out points the current  
performance of the guitar will be played as the guitar  
monitor sound. The previous recording is heard in any  
other case. The RECORD button lamp lights up when  
Punching In and turn off when Punching Out. (the  
[RHSL] remains flashing)  
3. Press the PLAY button to play back from a point  
slightly before the Punch In point.  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Punch In/Out Recording)  
Playback  
start point  
Punch In point  
(Rehearsal In)  
Punch Out point  
(Rehearsal Out)  
Playback  
end point  
6. When you finish rehearsing, press the STOP button.  
If you are still unsatisfied, repeat steps 3-5.  
Track 8  
Track 7  
Track 6  
Track 5  
Track 4  
Track 3  
Track 2  
Track 1  
Cancelling Rehearsal mode  
This part is changed.  
1. While holding down the STOP button, press the foot  
switch.  
[Rehsl Off] appears for a second, the flashing [RHSL]  
indicator in the A.PUNCH display area disappears, and  
Rehearsal mode is cancelled.  
All tracks are in playback  
monitoring mode.  
Only track 3 in input  
monitoring.  
All tracks are in playback  
monitoring mode.  
The sound is not recorded at  
this time.  
The RECORD button lamp  
flashes.  
<Hint>  
To rehearse repeatedly, set the AUTO RTN START point slightly  
before the Punch In point, and the AUTO RTN END point slightly  
before the Punch Out point.  
This will help you concentrate on your performance or check the  
recording level easily (especially since Manual Punch In/Out  
involves operating the foot switch operation as well as the  
VR800). (See <Hint-2> in the “Rehearsing Auto Punch In/Out  
recording” for more information.)  
Press the foot switch at the  
Punch In point.  
Press the foot switch at the  
Punch Out point.  
Manual Punch In/Out take  
You can proceed to record if you are satisfied with the recording level, foot switch timing, and rehearsal.  
Playback  
start point  
Punch In point  
(Take In)  
Punch Out point  
(Take Out)  
Playback  
end point  
Note: You cannot record a second take during the Manual Punch  
In/Out operation without stopping the VR800. That is, the VR800  
will continue playing after you finish recording a take, but you cannot  
record another take by pressing the foot switch.  
Track 8  
Track 7  
Track 6  
Track 5  
Track 4  
Track 3  
Track 2  
Track 1  
1. Confirm that Rehearsal mode is cancelled, and start  
playing the VR800 from a point slightly before the  
desired Punch In point.  
This part is changed.  
2. Play the guitar, accompanying the playback of  
tracks 1 to 8.  
All tracks are in playback  
monitoring mode.  
Only track 3 in input  
monitoring, and data will be  
recorded.  
All tracks are in playback  
monitoring mode.  
The RECORD button lamp  
lights up in this area.  
3. Press the foot switch at the desired Punch In point.  
Press the foot switch again at the desired Punch  
Out point.  
The VR800 will operate as follows. The VR800 enters  
recording mode at the Punch In point, and cancels  
recording mode at the Punch Out point.  
Press the foot switch at the  
Punch In point.  
Press the foot switch at the  
Punch Out point.  
4. Press the STOP button.  
5. Play track 3 and check the result of Punch In/Out.  
<Caution after Punch Out>  
At “Take” of punch out, the punch-in recording track will not  
immediately enter the repro monitor mode from the input  
monitor mode enter the repro monitor mode about two  
seconds after mute playback. This is a functional feature of  
VR800 and not a malfunction.  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s manual (Punch In/Out Recording)  
<Hint>  
You can use the PLAY button and the RECORD button, instead of using the foot switch. Follow the steps below.  
This method also does not allow you to record another take unless you stop the VR800 first.  
Procedure:  
1. Press the PLAY button to start playback from a point slightly before the Punch In point.  
2. Press the RECORD button while holding down the PLAY button at the desired Punch In point. (Punch In recording  
starts.)  
3. Press the PLAY button at the desired Punch Out point. (Recording is punched out.)  
• If you press only the RECORD button in both steps 2 and 3, you can rehearse Punch In/Out.  
Undo/Redo Manual Punch In/Out recording  
You can undo or redo Manual Punch In/Out recording.  
Press the UNDO/REDO key after recording is complete to restore the conditions that existed prior to the recording.  
Press the UNDO/REDO key again to restore the conditions that existed after the recording. Follow the notes  
below:  
Note-1: The Undo/Redo function is effective only when the VR800 is stopped.  
Note-2: The Undo/Redo is ineffective if you perform one of the following operations after you finish recording.  
• When a new recording is made.  
• While a new editing is executed (such as Copy & Paste, Move & Paste, or Erase).  
• When in the AUTO PUNCH ON mode, when the AUTO PUNCH IN point is passed in the PLAY (or RECORD) mode.  
• When the power is momentarily switched off.  
• When the program is changed.  
• When ejecting a removable SCSI disk that is the current drive.  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Recording to a Metronome Sound)  
Recording to a Metronome Sound  
This chapter explains how to record your performance while you are playing an instrument accompanied by  
a metronome based on the time signature and tempo specified in the Tempo Map. The metronome sound is  
output from track 8.  
Initialize the VR800 before the operation.  
If multiple Programs exist, first select the desired Program.  
<Notes>  
*
When you finish using the Metronome function, turn the function off in SETUP mode.  
*
When the Metronome function is on, you cannot record data on track 8, or youcannot play data recorded on track 8.  
DATA IN  
WORD OUT  
DATA OUT  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
STORE  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
P.EDIT  
LOC MEM  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
OPTICAL IN (adat IN)  
OPTICAL OUT (adat OUT)  
WORD IN  
METER  
OL  
-3  
-6  
-9  
-12  
-18  
-24  
-36  
-40  
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO  
PAGE SELECT  
9-16 ADAT IN  
1-8 ANALOG IN  
17-20 EFF RTN  
SETUP  
EQ/LO  
GAIN  
EQ/LO-MID  
GAIN  
EQ/HI-MID  
GAIN  
EQ/HI  
GAIN  
SELECTED EQ  
EQ ON  
EFF EDIT  
SYSTEM  
MIDI  
EFF1  
EFF2  
EQ LIBRARY  
EFF LIBRARY  
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS  
RECALL  
STORE  
RECALL  
STORE  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
SOLO  
ON  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
KEY MODE  
ROUTING/  
PHASE  
PAIR/  
GROUP  
REC BUSS  
SOLO  
SCENE MEMORY  
RECALL STORE  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
MMC SEND  
CHANNEL/  
METER  
CH VIEW  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
/-1  
+1/  
EXIT  
DATA  
+10  
0
+10  
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
+10  
0
+10  
0
0
0
-10  
-20  
0
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-30  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-10  
-10  
-10  
-10  
ENTER  
-20  
-20  
-20  
-20  
-20  
-40  
-60  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Digital Mixer  
Music Instrument  
Turning the Metronome function on  
Creating a Tempo Map  
* Turn the Metronome function on using the “Setting  
* Set the time signature using the “Setting a time  
the Metronome function” menu in SETUP mode.  
Refer to the “Setting the Metronome function” section  
onpage 93.  
signature” menu in SETUP mode.  
Refer to the “Setting a time signature” section on page  
90.  
* Set a tempo for a given point using the “Setting a  
tempo” in SETUP mode.  
Refer to the “Setting a tempo” section on page 92.  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Recording to a Metronome Sound)  
METER  
OL  
-3  
-6  
-9  
-12  
-18  
-24  
-36  
-40  
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
PAGE SELECT  
9-16 ADAT IN  
6
1-8 ANALOG IN  
17-20 EFF RTN  
12  
24  
SETUP  
EQ/LO  
GAIN  
EQ/LO-MID  
GAIN  
EQ/HI-MID  
GAIN  
EQ/HI  
GAIN  
SELECTED EQ  
EQ ON  
EFF EDIT  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
SYSTEM  
MIDI  
A
SYNC  
EFF1  
EFF2  
EQ LIBRARY  
EFF LIBRARY  
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS  
RECALL  
STORE  
RECALL  
STORE  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
5, 13  
1
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
SOLO  
ON  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
SOLO  
ON  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
KEY MODE  
ROUTING/  
PHASE  
PAIR/  
GROUP  
REC BUSS  
SOLO  
SCENE MEMORY  
RECALL STORE  
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
MMC SEND  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
CHANNEL/  
METER  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
CH VIEW  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
/-1  
+1/  
PGM SEL  
EXIT  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
DATA  
+10  
0
+10  
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
0
0
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
10  
0
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-30  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
ENTER  
-40  
-60  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
6
3, 8 11  
Music Instrument  
2, 7, 14  
4, 12  
8. Play the musical instrument in time with the  
metronome and adjust the recording level of the  
track to be recorded on the mixer.  
Checking the metronome sound  
1. Select the BAR/BEAT/CLK time base using the TIME  
BASE SEL key.  
9. After adjusting the recording level, stop the  
recorder and return to the top of the Program.  
2. Start playback from the beginning of the Program.  
Even if the selected Program does not have any recorded  
data, track 8 outputs the metronome sound and the  
VR800 counts time.  
Starting recording  
10. Hold down the RECORD button and press the  
3. Adjust the system so the sound output from track  
PLAY button to start recording.  
8 can be monitored with the mixer.  
You will hear the metronome sound output from track 8  
using the Tempo Map created earlier.  
The READY track will go to the input monitor mode just  
as when the recording level was adjusted. The time the  
level that was actually adjusted with the mixer will be  
4. After confirming the metronome sound, stop the  
recorder section and return to the top Program.  
recorded.  
11. Play the musical instrument in time with the  
metronome.  
Adjusting monitor/record level of the  
musical instrument  
Quitting recording  
12. Press the STOP button to stop the recorder.  
Checking the recorded sound  
5. Press the RECORD TRACK select key of the track  
to record the musical instrument on, and then put  
that track in the READY mode.  
6. Press the RECORD button.  
13. Turn OFF the ready track RECORD TRACK select  
key .  
The lamp of the RECORD button will flash and the READY  
track will go to the input monitor mode.  
14. Locate the top of the Program and start playback.  
Adjust and monitor the track playback sound recorded  
on the mixer. Since the metronome function still remains  
ON at this time, you can hear the metronome sound  
during playback of the recorded sounds when you turn  
up the track 8 monitor volume.  
7. Press the PLAY button and playback the Program  
from the top.  
Only the READY track will go to the input monitor mode  
(recording does not take place), and all other tracks will  
be in the reproduction monitor mode, therefore track 8  
plays back the metronome sound.  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Digital Recording)  
Digital Recording  
Digital recording from an external digital device  
This section explains how to record digital data from a device equipped with S/P DIF digital in/out (CD, MD, DAT,  
etc.) or a device equipped with adat digital in/out.  
To record S/P DIF digital signal or adat digital signal, use the “Setting input tracks” menu in SETUP mode to  
assign the input track. You can record digital data to the current program. The digital input track setting is  
applied to all programs.  
< Note >  
Input a digital source with a sampling frequency of 44.1kHz to the VR800.  
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
VR800  
DATA INPUT  
OPTICAL OUT (or adat OUT)  
OPTICAL OUT (or adat OUT)  
OPTICAL OUT (or adat OUT)  
External Digital Device (CD, MD, DAT, adat etc.)  
Connecting an external digital device  
* Connect the DATA IN jack of the VR800 with the OPTICAL OUT jack of an external digital device using an optical  
cable.  
If the digital device has only the COAXIAL (RCA pin) jack as a digital output, use a Fostex COP-1 (an optional optical/coaxial  
converter).  
Note: To avoid digital looping, remove the optical cable connected to the DATA OUT connector on the VR800.  
Selecting a Program to record  
* If multiple Programs exist, first select the desired Program using the Program Change function.  
• See page 33 for more information on Program Change.  
Assigning tracks and setting the digital-in clock  
* Use the “Setting a digital input track” menu to assign tracks and set the digital-in clock.  
To record adat signals, set the digital input track to [AdAt] and set the digital-in clock to [SYnC] (synchronous mode). To  
record S/P DIF signals, set the digital input track to any two tracks other than [AdAt], and set the digital-in clock to [SYnC]  
(synchronous mode).  
• See page 101 for more information on Digital input track setting.  
When you finish setting the parameters in SETUP mode, be sure to press the EXIT/NO key or the STOP key to exit SETUP  
mode.  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Digital Recording)  
Caution: Do not connect or disconnect an optical cable to or from the DATA IN jack of the VR800 while a track is assigned as digital  
input. Otherwise, noise may be induced to the VR800, affecting the connected digital device.  
Note: When setting up the digital input track, the tracks to be assigned to L and R cannot be the same, such as [L: 4] and [R: 4]. If  
setup is executed by mistakenly selecting the same track numbers for L and R, the number setup for the L channel will be given priority  
and “ - ” (no assign) will be setup automatically.  
Note: The [DIGITAL] indicator lights up on the display if the selected digital input track setting (AdAt or any two tracks) matches the  
type of the incoming digital signal (adat or SP DIF) and if the signal is correctly input. The [DIGITAL] indicator flashes to warn you if the  
track setting does not match the signal type or if the signal is not input correctly. In this case, check the connection and settings before  
you start recording.  
Selecting a recording track  
1. Press the RECORD TRACK select key of the recording track to set that track in ready mode.  
Note: You may record four tracks simultaneously on the current drive if it was formatted in [Master 4ch] mode. If you try to record adat  
digital signals by setting the digital input track to [AdAt], only the RECORD RACK select keys of tracks 1-4 are enabled. (The RECORD  
TRACK select keys of tracks 5-8 will not function.) That is, only channels 1-4 of the adat digital signals will be recorded. If you are using  
an MO disk as the current drive, you may record up to two tracks simultaneously, regardless of the record mode of the drive.  
Starting and quitting recording  
1. Locate the top of the Program.  
2. Make sure this [DIGITAL] indicator lights up on the display. Hold down the RECORD button and press the  
PLAY button to start recording on the VR800.  
3. Start playback on the external digital device.  
Check to see if the level meter of the VR800 is moving, responding to the input signal.  
4. When recording is complete, stop the VR800 and the external digital device.  
Digital recording to an external device  
This chapter describes how to digitally record data from an external MD, DAT, CD-R or adat that is connected to  
the VR800 containing the recorded songs. Two voluntary tracks from real tracks 1-8 can be freely assigned to the  
L and R od the digital output for digital output to an external device. Further, the data of all 8 tracks can also be  
output (when [adat] is selected). The current program is the program that can be digitally recorded. Note that  
the “Digital Output Track Setting” is effective for all programs though there may be several programs set at the  
time.  
Note: Data in the additional track cannot be directly digital recorded externally. In order to digital output the data in the  
additional track, it must first be transferred to a real track (use the track exchange function). For an explanation of the  
track exchange function, refer to page 66.  
< Note >  
Output a digital signal with a sampling frequency of 44.1kHz from the VR800.  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Digital Recording)  
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
VR800  
DATA OUTPUT  
OPTICAL IN (or adat IN)  
OPTICAL IN (or adat IN)  
OPTICAL IN (or adat IN)  
External Digital Device (MD, DAT, adat etc.)  
Connecting an external digital device  
* Connect the DATA OUT jack of the VR800 with the OPTICAL IN jack of an external digital device using an  
optical cable.  
If the digital device has only the COAXIAL (RCA pin) jack as a digital output, use an optional COP-1 (optical - coaxial converter).  
Note: The VR800 switches the DATA OUTPUT connector between an S/P DIF digital signal (Optical) and an adat digital signal  
during setting of the digital input track in Setup mode. Both signals use the same connector configuration, but carry different  
data.  
Note: To avoid digital looping, remove the optical cable connected to the DATA IN connector on the VR800.  
Selecting a playback program  
* If multiple Programs exist, first select the desired Program using the Program Change function.  
• See page 33 for more information on Program Change.  
Setting a digital output track  
1. Select the desired track using the “Setting digital output tracks” menu in SETUP mode.  
You can select any two track (S/P DIF digital signal) from tracks 1–8, or all eight tracks (adat digital signal).  
Refer to “Setting digital output tracks” in the “Changing the Initial Settings (SETUP Mode)” chapter on page 103 for more  
information on setting a digital output track. When you finish setting the parameters in SETUP mode, be sure to press the  
EXIT/NO key or the STOP key to exit SETUP mode.  
Note: When setting up the digital output track, the tracks to be assigned to L and R cannot be the same, such as [L: 4] and [R:  
4]. If setup is executed by mistakenly selecting the same track numbers for L and R, the number setup for the L channel will be  
given priority and “-” (no assign) will be setup automatically for R. In other words, L channel will be setup to the specified track  
and R channel will be setup to no assign.  
Note: You may play four tracks simultaneously from disks formatted in Master 4ch mode. Even if you set the digital output  
track to [AdAt], only tracks 1-4 will be output, and tracks 5-8 will be ignored.  
Starting and quitting recording  
1. Locate the top of the Program.  
2. Start recording on the external digital device.  
3. Press the PLAY button on the VR800 to start playback.  
Digital data is output from the selected track and recorded on the external digital device.  
4. When recording is complete, stop the VR800 and the external digital device.  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Storing a Locate Point <Edit Point>)  
Storing a Locate Point (Edit Point)  
You can store specific individual time data (time, bar/beat/clock) in each memory key (*).  
The time data stored is used as an “Editing Point” to execute “Locate Point” or Auto Punch In/Out, Copy & Paste,  
Move & Paste or Erase. You can also store 99 (Locate Number 01-99) time data in the LOCATE key, in addition to  
the Memory key, to enable locate only features. This chapter will describe how to store specific data in the  
memory key and how to edit and re-store data is already stored in the memory key.  
The data stored in each memory are used for the following operations.  
* Memory key  
When you set the IN/OUT points for Auto Punch In/Out, IN/OUT points for Copy & Clip/Move & Clip, and START/END  
points for Auto Return/Auto Repeat, END points.  
* Locating the AUTO PUNCH IN point.  
* Recording start point for the Auto Punch In/Out operation.  
* Paste start point for the Copy & Paste or Move & Paste operation.  
* Erase start point for the Erase operation.  
AUTO PUNCH IN key  
* Locating the AUTO PUNCH OUT point.  
* Recording end point for the Auto Punch In/Out operation.  
* Erase end point for the Erase operation.  
AUTO PUNCH OUT key  
CLIPBOARD IN key  
* Locating the CLIPBOARD IN point.  
* Copy start point for copying or moving data to the clipboard during the  
Copy & Paste or Move & Paste operation.  
* Locating the CLIPBOARD OUT point.  
* Copy end point for copying or moving data to the clipboard during the  
Copy & Paste or Move & Paste operation.  
CLIPBOARD OUT key  
* Locating the AUTO RTN START point.  
AUTO RTN START key  
AUTO RTN END key  
* Locate end point from AUTO RTN END in Auto Return or Auto Repeat  
modes.  
* Locating the AUTO RTN END point.  
* Locate start point to AUTO RTN START in Auto Return or Auto Repeat  
modes.  
<Note on storing the locate point>  
When you set the IN/OUT points for Auto Punch In/Out, IN/OUT points for Copy & Clip/Move  
& Clip, and START/END points for Auto Return/Auto Repeat, make sure that IN points precede  
the OUT points and START points precede the END points.  
You can also store time data in the LOCATE key, in addition to each memory key explained above. You can store up to  
99 individual time data in the LOCATE key for locate only features. Store the data by specifying Locate Number to locate  
the intended time data. Note that the LOCATE key always stores the last located time data in real-time. This Locate  
Number is stored as 00, and does not require a Locate Number specification to locate it.  
Simply pressing the LOCATE key directly, will locate that data. This becomes an advantage since it is possible to  
repeatedly locate the last located point.  
You can edit the data stored in the LOCATE key, as so with the data stored in the Memory key. For more details refer to  
page 57.  
* You can store locate points for each Program. (You need to select a Program first.)  
* The data can be also saved or loaded even after the Song data is saved or loaded.  
* All locate points stored in the memory keys will be maintained after you turn off the VR800.  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Storing a Locate Point <Edit Point>)  
Storing and editing the locate points to the memory keys  
• Select the desired Time Base using the TIME BASE SEL key an if you wish to use a Time Base other ABS.  
• The stored or edited locate points are used only in the currently-selected Program.  
Storing in real-time  
You can store the locate point (in the ABS, MTC, or BAR/BEAT/CLK Time Base) in real-time while the VR800 is  
playing.  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
4
2
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
3
1
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
1. Press the PLAY button to play back data.  
4. Press the desired memory key.  
The STORE key lamp turns off.  
2. When the point you wish to store is reached, press  
the HOLD/> key.  
The captured time value (or bar/beat/clock value) is  
stored in the memory key. After the data is stored, the  
VR800 displays the previous Time Base and continues  
playback.  
The time value or bar/beat/clock value of the point is  
captured. The VR800 enters data edit mode.  
Flashing  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
You can omit Step 2 to speed operation.  
ABS  
LOC  
M
S
F
SF  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
5. Press the STOP button.  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
• If you set “BAR/BEAT Resolution mode” in SETUP mode  
to ON, the VR800 will round off the CLK value of the captured  
bar/beat/clock value. That is, the locate point will be at the  
beginning of the beat (00). Refer to page 103 for more  
information.  
3. Press the STORE key.  
The STORE key lamp lights up.  
Note: The following menu (##=number from 00-99)  
appears when pressing the STORE key. This menu is  
used to store data in the LOCATE ley, described later.  
Ignore this menu and go to the next step when storing  
data in the memory key.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Storing a Locate Point <Edit Point>)  
Editing and storing locate data  
If you know the position of the desired locate point, follow the steps below.  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
4
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
3
2
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
1, 2  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
2
1. Press the HOLD/> key while the VR800 is stopped.  
3. Press the STORE key.  
The currently-displayed time value (or bar/beat/clock value)  
The [Press LOC:] menu will appear as indicated before.  
is captured and the VR800 enters data edit mode.  
Ignore this go to the next step.  
Flashing  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
ABS  
LOC  
M
S
F
SF  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
4. Press the desired memory key.  
2. Press the HOLD/> key, REWIND button, or the F FWD  
button to move the flashing cursor on the time value  
digit, and use the JOG dial to increase or decrease the  
value.  
The STORE key lamp will turn off.  
The input time value (or bar/beat/clock value) is stored  
in the corresponding memory key.  
Editing and storing data  
You can recall data stored in the memory key, edit it, and store it. again  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the memory key  
that stores the data you wish to edit.  
The stored data appears on the display and the VR800  
enters data edit mode.  
3. Press the STORE key.  
The [Press LOC:] menu will appear as indicated before.  
Ignore this go to the next step.  
4. Press the memory key that you pressed in Step 1  
again.  
2. Press the HOLD/> key, REWIND button, or the F FWD  
button to move the flashing cursor on the time value  
digit, and use the JOG dial to increase or decrease the  
value.  
The STORE key lamp will turn off. The edited data is  
stored, and the VR800 displays the previous Time Base  
indication.  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Storing a Locate Point <Edit Point>)  
You can store the edited data in a memory key other than the one you pressed when you recalled the data.  
For example, you can recall the AUTO PUNCH IN point data, edit it, and store it to the AUTO PUNCH OUT key.  
* Refer to page 36 for more information on Auto Punch In/Out.  
* Refer to page 61 for more information on Copy & Paste, Move & Paste, and Erase.  
* Refer to page 54 for more information on Auto Return and Auto Repeat.  
You can also use the Preview function to edit the stored locate points (edit points). Refer to “Preview Function” on page 59 for more  
information.  
Storing and editing LOCATE key  
You can store up to 99 individual time data in the LOCATE key for Locate only operations.  
The time data stored can also be assigned with a specific locate number from 01-99. This means the desired  
locate number can be specified to locate that specific time data. The memory data of the LOCATE key can also be  
edited in the same manner as the data in the Memory key. After editing the data the LOCATE key can locate that  
point, or even be re-stored as data for other Memory keys.  
<Note>  
* The last data located with the Memory key or LOCATE key is constantly stored as LOCATE number 00. However, this data  
is constantly replaced after every LOCATE command. Therefore, do not use Locate Number 00 for independent Locate  
data.  
* You cannot preview the data stored in the LOCATE key, though it is possible to preview data stored in other Memory keys.  
* If you use a time base that is not an ABS time, there is a need to priory switch to the desired time base using the TIME BASE  
SEL key.  
* Any editing or storing of data for the LOCATE point is valid only for the program that is currently started up.  
Storing in real-time  
You can store the locate point (in the ABS, MTC, or BAR/BEAT/CLK Time Base) in real-time while the VR800 is  
playing.  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
2
3
4
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
5
6
1
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Storing a Locate Point <Edit Point>)  
1. Press the PLAY button to start playback.  
5. Next press the LOCATE key.  
The time base (or bar/beat/clock) put on hold is stored  
as data in the LOCATE number selected. The system will  
return to the original time base when the storage process  
is completed, and playback is resumed.  
2. Press the HOLD/> key in the store location.  
When you press the HOLD/> key the time base (or bar/  
beat/clock) will return to the edit mode of the data put  
on hold.  
Flashing  
6. After completing the store process, press the STOP  
button to stop the recorder section.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
LOC  
M
S
F
SF  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
You can omit Step 2 to speed operation.  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
• If you set “BAR/BEAT Resolution mode” in SETUP mode  
to ON, the VR800 will round off the CLK value of the captured  
bar/beat/clock value. That is, the locate point will be at the  
beginning of the beat (00). Refer to page 103 for more  
information.  
3. Press the STORE key. (the STORE key lamp lights up)  
The memory number selection menu will appear, as  
follows.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
4. Select the LOCATE number desired using the JOG  
dial.  
LOCATE number from 00-99 are selectable. However,  
select a number other then 00.  
Editing and storing locate data  
If you know the position of the desired locate point, follow the steps below.  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
1, 2  
5
3
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
2, 4  
2
1. Press the HOLD/> key while the VR800 is stopped.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
The currently-displayed time value (or bar/beat/clock value)  
is captured and the VR800 enters data edit mode.  
ABS  
Flashing  
LOC  
M
S
F
SF  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Storing a Locate Point <Edit Point>)  
2. Press the HOLD/> key, REWIND button, or the F FWD  
4. Select the LOCATE number desired using the JOG  
dial.  
button to move the flashing cursor on the time value  
digit, and use the JOG dial to increase or decrease  
the value.  
5. Press the LOCATE key.  
The edit time data is stored as the time data for the  
selected LOCATE number.  
3. Press the STORE key. (the STORE key lamp lights up.)  
Edit and re-store data that is already stored  
RECALL the desired time data already stored in the LOCATE key, edit that data and re-store it.  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
1, 2  
5
3
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
2, 4  
2
1. Press the LOCATE key, while holding down the  
•If the STORE key is press instead of the LOCATE key at  
this stage, it becomes possible to directly LOCATE the  
time data of the selected LOCATE number. For more  
details refer to the next section on “Location Functions.”  
SHIFT key, while the VR800 is stopped.  
The menu to select the LOCATE number will appear.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
5. You can use the JOG dial to input the desired  
LOCATE number.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
6. Press the LOCATE key.  
The edit time data is stored as the time data for the  
selected LOCATE number.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select the desired LOCATE  
number, then press the LOCATE key.  
The data edit mode will appear when the data stored in  
the selected LOCATE number appears.  
Flashing  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
LOC  
M
S
F
SF  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Locate Function)  
Locate Function  
The VR800 swiftly locates (it moves the current location of the recorder section) the desired point when necessary.  
Locate include edit points (in ABS time, MTC time, or in bar/beat/clock) that are stored for the Copy, Move, Paste,  
Erase, or Auto Punch In/Out operations.  
They also include Locate by specifying a voluntary time, and Locate specifying a voluntary Locate Number (01-  
99), as well as Locate directly to the recording end point in a Program (REC END). An application of he Locate  
function includes auto functions such as Auto Play, Auto Return and Auto Repeat.  
Direct Locate  
The Direct Locate function enables you to locate the following points:  
• Specify the locate number to locate data  
• Locate the beginning of the Program (LOCATE ABS 0)  
Press the REWIND button while holding down the STOP  
1. Press the LOCATE key, while holding down the SHIFT  
button.  
key.  
The VR800 will immediately locate the beginning of the currently-  
selected Program.  
The locate number selection menu appears.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
STOP  
RECORD  
PLAY  
REW  
F FWD  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
2. Turn the JOG dial or press the LOCATE key, while  
holding down the SHIFT key to select the desired  
number.  
• Locate the recording end point of the Program (LOCATE  
REC END)  
3. Press the LOCATE key once.  
Press the F FWD button while holding down the STOP  
button.  
The time stored in the selected locate number appears.  
The VR800 will immediately locate the end point of the currently-  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
selected Program.  
ABS  
LOC  
M
S
F
SF  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
STOP  
RECORD  
PLAY  
REW  
F FWD  
4. Press the LOCATE key again.  
The time data of the selected locate number is swiftly located.  
The located time data is constantly stored as time data in locate  
number “00.”  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
• Locate the position stored in one of the memory keys  
Press the desired memory key, then press the LOCATE  
• Locate a specified point  
Refer to “Editing and storing locate data” in the chapter “Storing a  
Locate Point (Edit Point)” for information on how to edit the data and  
on pressing the LOCATE key instead of the STORE key. The point  
at specified time value (or bar/beat/clock value) will be located  
immediately.  
key.  
The VR800 will locate the point (edit point) stored in the  
corresponding memory key immediately.  
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
AUTO PUNCH  
IN  
OUT  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
• Locate the last-located point  
PREVIEW  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
STORE  
Directly press the LOCATE key.  
PGM SEL  
The time data of Locate number 00 is located. Locate number 00 is  
always update with the last data located (excluding LOCATE ABS 0  
and LOCATE REC END). Therefore, you will locate the data in  
memory number 00 every time you directly press the LOCATE key.  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
LOCATE  
The located time data is always stored as time data in locate number  
“00.”  
LOC MEM  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Locate Function)  
Auto Play  
The Auto Play function allows the VR800 to start play back automatically from the located point.  
AUTO PLAY mode should be turned on before you execute the Direct Locate function described above.  
Note: This function is effective within 24 ABS hours. Therefore, if playback continues over the recording end point, the  
VR800 will still continue counting the time. Also, when the VR800 locates ABS REC END, it will continue counting the  
time from the recording end point. (However, the VR800 does not access the disk after reaching the recording end point.)  
<Example: Operation at locating to the AUTO PUNCH IN point.>  
AUTO PUNCH IN point  
PLAYBACK  
PLAYBACK  
LOCATE  
LOCATE  
START  
LOCATE  
LOCATE  
START  
1. Press the AUTO RTN/AUTO PLAY key to turn on  
the [PLAY] indicator on the bottom of the display.  
You can set a preroll time in the [Preroll Time ?] menu in  
SETUP mode so that the VR800 will start playback preroll  
time before the locate point. You can set the preroll time  
from 0 to 10 seconds. Refer to the chapter “Changing the  
Initial Settings (SETUP Mode)” on page 94.  
AUTO  
Lights up  
PLAY  
2. Press the LOCATE key, or memory key.  
The VR800 locates the point and plays as shown in the  
diagram.  
3. Press the STOP button to stop the VR800.  
Auto Return  
This function allows the VR800 to play data up to the AUTO RTN END point, then automatically locate the AUTO  
RTN START point as shown in the diagram below. To enable this function, AUTO RTN mode should be on and the  
AUTO RTN START point and AUTO RTN END point should already be set.  
<Operation of the Auto Return mode.>  
AUTO RTN END point  
AUTO RTN START point  
PLAYBACK  
PLAYBACK  
START  
Automatic locating to the AUTO RTN START point  
subsequent to playback to the AUTO RTN END point.  
LOCATE  
STOP  
3. Start playback a little before the AUTO RTN END  
point.  
1. Store the AUTO RTN START and AUTO RTN END  
points.  
The VR800 operates as shown in the diagram.  
Refer to the chapter “Storing a Locate Point (Edit Point)”  
on page 48 for information on storing the desired points  
in the AUTO RTN START key and the AUTO RTN END  
key.  
You can set a preroll time in the [Preroll Time ?] menu in  
SETUP mode so that the VR800 will start playback preroll  
time before the locate point. You can set the preroll time  
from 0 to 10 seconds. Refer to the chapter “Changing the  
Initial Settings (SETUP Mode)” on page 94.  
2. Press the AUTO RTN/AUTO PLAY key to turn on  
the [RTN] indicator on the bottom of the display.  
AUTO  
Lights up  
RTN  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Locate Function)  
Auto Repeat  
The Auto Repeat function allows the VR800 to repeat playback up to the AUTO RTN END point, automatically  
locate the AUTO RTN START point, then play up to the AUTO RTN END point until you cancel the function by  
pressing the STOP button. To enable this function, both AUTO PLAY mode and AUTO RTN mode should be  
turned on, and the AUTO RTN START point and the AUTO RTN END point should already be set.  
Using this function will facilitate the Auto Punch In/Out and Manual Punch In/Out rehearsal. See “Hint”  
after the following section.  
<Operation of the Auto Repeat mode.>  
AUTO RTN START point  
AUTO RTN END point  
PLAYBACK  
LOCATE  
PLAYBACK  
START  
3. Start playback a little before the AUTO RTN START  
point.  
1. Store the AUTO RTN START and AUTO RTN END  
points.  
The VR800 operates as shown in the diagram, and stops  
Refer to the chapter “Storing a Locate Point (Edit Point)”  
on page 48 for information on storing the desired points  
in the AUTO RTN START key and the AUTO RTN END  
key.  
at the AUTO RTN START point.  
You can set a preroll time in the [Preroll Time?] menu in  
SETUP mode so that the VR800 will start playback preroll  
time before the locate point. You can set the preroll time  
from 0 to 10 seconds. Refer to the chapter “Changing the  
Initial Settings (SETUP Mode)” on page 94.  
2. Press the AUTO RTN/AUTO PLAY key to turn on  
the [PLAY] and [RTN] indicator on the bottom of  
the display.  
AUTO  
PLAY  
RTN  
Lights up  
<Hint>  
You can make repeated Auto Punch In/Out rehearsal much easier and quicker by using the Auto Repeat function.  
Set the AUTO RTN START point prior to the AUTO PUNCH IN point, and set the AUTO RTN END point after the AUTO  
PUNCH OUT point. The recorder will repeat the operation automatically so you can concentrate on your rehearsal.  
Cancel Auto Repeat mode before you record a take.  
The VR800 will play this range repeatedly for rehearsal, which makes it easy for you to check the recording level and practice  
your performance.  
AUTO PUNCH IN point  
AUTO PUNCH OUT point  
AUTO RTN START point  
AUTO RTN END point  
Rehearsal range  
PLAYBACK  
PLAYBACK  
START  
LOCATE  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Cue & Review Function)  
Cue & Review Function  
This chapter explains how to use the “Cue & Review” function with the REWIND button, the F FWD button, and  
the SHUTTLE function, and also explains “Digital Scrubbing” with the scrub mode function. During Cue/Review  
and Digital Scrubbing you will hear the sound recorded on the disk, which makes it easy for you to swiftly locate  
the desired point without failure while listening to the sounds.  
The prerequisite of the following operation is that the time base is ABS, however, the operation can be executed in any time  
base. To execute this function with a non-ABS time base there is a need to priory switch over to the desired time base.  
Cue & Review function using the REWIND and F FWD buttons  
You may cue & review the audio data at three-times speed while the recorder is playing.  
4. Press the PLAY button again to restore the original  
play back speed.  
1. Press the PLAY button to play the audio data.  
2. Press the F FWD button during playback.  
[FWD>] appears on the display, and the VR800 cues in  
the forward direction at three-times speed.  
5. Press the REWIND button instead of the F FWD  
button.  
[<RWD] appears on the display, and the VR800 cues in  
the reverse direction at three-times speed.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
M
S
F
PGM  
SCSI  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
ABS  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
M
S
F
PGM  
SCSI  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
3. Adjust the monitor sound of the track to monitor  
on the mixer.  
6. Press the PLAY button to restore the original  
playback speed.  
Cue & Review function using the SHUTTLE feature  
You can use the SHUTTLE mode for 1-time~64-times Cue/Review while playing back the recorder section.  
3. Adjust the monitor sound of the track to monitor  
on the mixer.  
1. Press the PLAY button to start playback.  
2. Hold down the SHIFT key and turn the JOG dial  
4. Release the SHIFT key to cancel the cue and review  
clockwise or counter-clockwise.  
operation.  
Turning the JOG dial clockwise qqwill change the cueing  
speed. Turning the JOG dial counter-clockwise will change  
the reviewing speed.  
The VR800 resumes playback at the original speed.  
The VR800 displays the selected cue or review speed,  
which you can select from normal, two-times, four-times,  
eight-times, 16-times, 32-times, and 64-times speed.  
As long as you are holding down the SHIFT key, playback  
continues at the selected speed.  
Note: The cue and review operation does not affect pitch.  
Because the VR800 performs this function by skipping  
part of data during playback.  
Note: When the beginning of the disk is reached during  
the review operation, the VR800 starts qnormal playback,  
even if you are still holding down the SHIFT key. When  
the end of the disk (ABS time: 23H 59M 59S) is reached  
during the cue operation, the VR800 stops and the PLAY  
button lamp flashes.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
M
S
F
PGM  
SCSI  
Display of 16-times review  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
44.1kHz  
F
DIGITAL  
ABS  
M
S
PGM  
SCSI  
Display of 32-times cue  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Cue & Review Function)  
Digital scrubbing using the SCRUB function  
You may perform digital scrubbing using the “SCRUB Function” of the VR800 while the recorder section is  
stopped. The scrub function allows digital scrubbing for each track recorded. The display will show the envelope  
indication of the track selected.  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
2, 5  
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
IN  
OUT  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
1
3
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
STOP  
RECORD  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
6
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
1. Press the SCRUB key while the VR800 is stopped.  
The SCRUB key’s lamp lights up. The VR800 enters scrub  
mode and displays [Select TRK], instrucing you to select  
the desired track.  
<Turning the JOG dial in the forward direction>  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
M
S
F
SF  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
Playback point  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
t
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
<Turning the JOG dial in the reverse direction>  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Note: You can select one track at a time.  
ABS  
If you try to select two or more RECORD TRACK select  
key, the VR800 will ignore your operation.  
M
S
F
SF  
Playback point  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
2. Press the desired RECORD TRACK select key to  
t
select a track for digital scrubbing.  
4. Adjust the monitor sound of the selected track so  
that it can be monitored on the mixer.  
The screen changes, indicating that the VR800 is in  
“STILL” status (Scrub mode is “still”).  
The selected RECORD TRACK select key’s lamp flashes.  
5. Press the RECORD TRACK select key of the desired  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
record track to select another track.  
[Please Wait!] will briefly appear and then go to the  
ABS  
M
S
F
SF  
envelope indication of the selected track.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
6. Press the STOP button to stop the digital  
scrubbing.  
3. Turn the JOG dial to perform digital scrubbing.  
The envelope of data recorded on the selected track  
appears during digital scrubbing.  
Doing so will turn OFF the scrub mode. The VR800 will  
return to the time base indication prior to turning the  
envelope function ON.  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Preview Function)  
Preview Function  
The preview function enables you to repeatedly audition the rise (fade in) or the fall (fade out) of the sound data  
at a locate point (edit point) that is stored in the AUTO PUNCH IN/OUT, AUTO RTN START/END, or CLIPBOARD  
IN/OUT key. This is also called “point rehearsal.” With this function, you can check the locate points in real-  
time. You can also use this function to fine-tune the position of the locate points while previewing the sound.  
This function is effective only when the VR800 is stopped.  
Executing the Preview function  
Previewing the fall of the sound (fade out)  
Previewing the rise of the sound (fade in)  
1. While holding down the SHIFT key, press the AUTO END  
START key, the AUTO PUNCH IN key, or the CLIPBOARD  
OUT key.  
1. While holding down the SHIFT key, press the AUTO RTN  
START key, the AUTO PUNCH OUT key, or CLIPBOARD IN  
key.  
The VR800 repeats playback of the “fall sound” at the  
locate point (edit point).  
The VR800 repeats playback the “rise sound” at the locate  
point (edit point).  
AUTO RTN  
CPBOARD  
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
AUTO PUNCH  
AUTO PUNCH  
IN  
OUT  
START  
OUT  
IN  
OUT  
STT  
IN  
OU
END  
PREVIEW  
PREVIEW  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
HOLD/  
EDIT  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
STORE  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
PGM SEL  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
VARI PITCH  
P.EDIT  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
SHIFT  
LOC MEM  
<Display indication during the Preview operation>  
<Display indication during the Preview operation>  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
ABS  
F
F
LOC  
H
M
S
SF  
LOC  
H
M
S
SF  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Approx. 2sec.  
Approx. 2sec.  
1 sec. (mute playback)  
1 sec. (normal playback)  
1 sec. (normal playback)  
1 sec. (mute playback)  
The sound rises at the memory point.  
The sound falls at the memory point.  
As shown in the diagram, one-second of data prior to  
the locate point is muted during playback. The mute is  
off (fade in) at the locate point and the sound is played  
back for one second.  
As shown in the diagram, one-second of data prior to  
the locate point is played back, then muted (fade out) at  
the locate point. The muted playback continues for one  
second. The VR800 will repeat this operation until you  
quit the Preview function.  
The VR800 will repeat this operation until you quit the  
Preview function.  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Preview Function)  
2. To adjust the monitor sound of the selected track  
so that it can be monitored on the mixer.  
3. Press the STOP button or the EXIT/NO key.  
Note: If data stored in each memory key is in the initial state,  
all memory keys will be in ABS time 00H 00M 00S.  
In other words, the program head value is in the memory. Should  
fade out preview be executed in this condition, the [Void Data !]  
message and memory data [00H 00M 00S] will alternately flash  
in the display as a warning. However, for fade in preview, this  
will function as the memory data [00H 00M 00S] point.  
Trimming the sound while previewing  
You can trim the position of the locate point (edit point) using the JOG dial while you preview the sound.  
At this time, you can also adjust the size of the trimming steps (the amount of offset controlled by the JOG dial).  
Trimming allows you to fine-tune the position of the locate point stored in the memory keys while previewing the  
sound.  
Use this function to change the Auto Punch In/Out points, the start point of Copy & Paste and Move & Paste, and  
the start and end points of the Erase function.  
<Notes>  
• You can audition the result of trimming during the next preview. That is, if you trim the position while previewing the  
sound for the first time, you can check the result when you preview the sound next time.  
• If the locate point is shifted outside the range of the preview playback as a result of trimming, [Void Data!] and the  
locate point indication appear alternately. In this case, you cannot use the Preview function. Trim the position again  
so that it will be within the playback range.  
• When Auto Punch mode is turned on and you trim the Auto Punch In or Auto Punch Out point while previewing the  
sound with [Void Data!] indicated on the display, Auto Punch mode will be cancelled.  
1. Start previewing the sound by following the steps  
described on the previous page.  
3. To change the unit of trimming, press the HOLD/>  
key, the REWIND button, or the F FWD button.  
These buttons will change the trimming unit as follows:  
2. Use the JOG dial to trim the position.  
When previewing starts, the unit of JOG trimming flashes  
on the screen. For example, value of SF (sub-frame) flashes  
if ABS Time Base or MTC Time Base is selected. CLK (clock)  
flashes if BAR/BEAT/CLK is selected.  
Time Base  
ABS or MTC  
BAR/BEAT/CLK  
HOLD/> key  
or  
The flashing value also indicates the position you can  
trim.  
M
S
BAR  
BAR  
H
F
F
CLK  
CLK  
SF  
F FWD button  
Example: Time Base is ABS (value of SF flashes.)  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
M
S
H
SF  
REWIND button  
ABS  
Flash  
F
LOC  
H
M
S
SF  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
4. Trim the position at the selected unit (digit).  
5. Press the STOP button or the EXIT/NO key.  
The trimmed locate point (edit point) data will be stored  
in the corresponding memory key.  
Example: Time Base is BAR/BEAT/CLK (CLK flashes.)  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
BAR  
CLK  
Flash  
LOC  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Editing Tracks)  
Editing Tracks  
The VR800 features speedy, non-linear, non-destructive editing of independent audio tracks and uses a zip, MO  
disk, fixed hard disk or 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk as the recording media. The following edit functions enable you  
to edit tracks. Press the EDIT key on the control panel to access the edit menu.  
<Edit functions>  
Copy & Paste  
Track Exchange  
You can copy a specific range of data from a specific track and  
paste it to the same or a different track.  
You can swap data between tracks.  
Monaural track data can be swapped between Real tracks 1–8  
and Additional tracks 9–24. Multiple-track data can be swapped  
between Real tracks 1–8 and Additional tracks 9–16, and  
Additional tracks 17-24 by eight-track unit.  
Move & Paste  
You can move a specific range of data from a specific track and  
paste it to the same or a different track.  
Erase  
You can erase a specific range of data from a specific track or  
from all tracks.  
Note: These edit functions are available for the currently-selected Program. You can perform Copy & Paste, Move & Paste,  
and Erase operations (except for Track Exchange) for data recorded in the Real tracks.  
If the disk contains multiple Programs, you need to select the desired Program first to perform the track edit operation. Do not  
select another Program until you finish the edit operation. Otherwise, you may lose or incorrectly edit another Program.  
Copy & Paste and Move & Paste  
Copy & Paste and Move & Paste might seem like the same function. However, they are different, as shown in the  
diagram. Remember this difference when you start using these functions.  
• Copy & Paste  
• Move & Paste  
Using the Copy & Paste function enables you to copy a  
specific range of data from a specific track to the clipboard  
as shown below (this is called [Copy Clip] operation on the  
VR800), then paste the data at a specific point in a specific  
track. The number of copy source tracks and the number of  
destination tracks are the same. That is, if you copy mono  
track data, you can paste it to a mono track. If you copy  
adjacent odd/even tracks (e.g., track 1 and track 2), you can  
paste it to adjacent odd/even tracks. The data on the clipboard  
remains as it is. You can paste it as many times as you wish.  
Move & Paste is almost the same as Copy & Paste.  
As shown in the figure, it allows you to move a specific range  
of data from a specific track to the clipboard (this is called  
[Move Clip] on the VR800), and paste it to a destination track.  
The difference from Copy & Paste is that the data on the source  
track and the clipboard will be erased when you paste the  
data to the destination. That is, you cannot paste the moved  
data repeatedly.  
CLIPBOARD IN point  
CLIPBOARD OUT point  
Move Clip  
CLIPBOARD OUT point  
CLIPBOARD IN point  
Move source track  
Copy source track  
Copy Clip  
AUTO PUNCH IN point  
AUTO PUNCH IN point  
Paste  
Paste  
Paste destination track  
Paste destination track  
As shown in the drawing, points for copy or move are called the CLIPBOARD IN point for the copy (or move)  
starting point, and CLIPBOARD OUT point for the ending point, and the paste starting point is called the AUTO  
PUNCH IN point.  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Editing Tracks)  
Follow the steps below to perform the Copy & Paste or Move  
& Paste operation.  
Note: If you select non-adjacent tracks, such as tracks 1 and 3,  
or tracks 1, 2, and 4, the copied (or moved) data will be pasted  
Store the copy (or move) start point (CLIPBOARD IN point),  
end point (CLIPBOARD OUT point), and the paste start point  
(AUTO PUNCH IN point).  
back to the copy (or move) source tracks.  
2. Press the EDIT key repeatedly until [Copy Clip (or  
[Move Clip]) flashes on the display.  
Select [Copy Clip] to execute Copy & Paste.  
Check the stored edit points using the Preview function and  
make adjustments if necessary.  
Select [Move Clip] to execute Move & Paste.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
Specify the copy (or move) source track, and copy (or move)  
the data to the clipboard.  
SCSI  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
Specify the destination track and the number of times for the  
paste operation (repeated paste), and execute the paste  
operation.  
The copy or move operation will complete immediately.  
The display briefly indicates [COMPLETED !], then flashes  
the [Copy Paste] message (or the [Move Paste] message).  
The VR800 enters standby mode for the paste operation.  
The lamps of the selected RECORD TRACK select keys  
continue to flash.  
Storing the edit points  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
1. Refer to the “Storing and editing the locate points  
to the memory keys” section for information on  
storing the copy (or move) start and end points,  
and the paste start point.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
This is indicated after copy/clip.  
This is indicated after move/clip.  
Store the copy (or move) start point to the CLIPBOARD IN  
key, the end point to the CLIPBOARD OUT key, and store  
the paste start point to the AUTO PUNCH IN key.  
Note: Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key without selecting a track  
in Step 1 will cause the display to indicate an alarm message [Select  
TRK !]. Select a track, then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
• See “Storing and editing the locate points to the memory keys” on  
page 48.  
Now the sound data to be pasted has been copied (or  
moved) to the clipboard, you can check the data on the  
clipboard by following the steps below. If there is no  
problem with the data, you can proceed to the paste  
operation.  
Checking and adjusting the edit points  
After you store the edit points, you can check them on the  
display by pressing the corresponding keys. You may also  
adjust the points. This section explains how to preview and  
fine-tune the edit points using the Preview function.  
Checking the clipboard data  
1. While the recorder section is stopped, press and  
hold down the SHIFT key and press the memory  
key for which you wish to check the edit point.  
You can preview “fade in” at the CLIPBOARD IN point,  
“fade out” at the CLIPBOARD OUT point, and “fade out”  
at AUTO PUNCH IN point.  
* Hold down the STOP button and press the PLAY button.  
The VR800 indicates whether the sound data on the  
clipboard is a copied data or moved data ([Copy Clip] or  
[Move Clip]) and plays the data (this is called clipboard  
playback). Monitor the playback sound through the mixer  
channels that correspond to the copied (or moved) tracks.  
During clipboard playback, the lamp of the RECORD TRACK  
select key for the copied (or moved) track will flash.  
2. Trim the edit point while previewing.  
• Refer to “Preview Function” on page 59 for more information.  
* Press the EDIT key again to get ready for the paste  
operation. [Copy Paste] or [Move Paste] flashes on the  
display.  
Executing Copy (or Move)  
1. Press the RECORD TRACK select key of the copy  
(or move) source track to set it READY.  
Select from mono tracks or adjacent odd-even tracks (1-  
2, 3-4, 5-6, 7-8).  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Editing Tracks)  
Executing Paste  
Undo/Redo Paste  
You can undo or redo a Copy & Paste and Move & Paste  
operation.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key again.  
The display indication enables you to set the number of  
the paste operations. The number and [SURE ?] flash.  
At this time, the flashing RECORD TRACK select key’s lamp  
becomes continuously lit.  
To restore the data that existed prior to the paste operation,  
press the UNDO/REDO key.  
To restore the pasted data after you undo the paste  
operation, press the UNDO/REDO key again.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
SURE ?  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
Note: The Undo/Redo function is effective only when the VR800  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
is stopped.  
Note: If you perform one of the following operations after you use  
the Copy & Paste or Move and Paste operation, the Undo/Redo  
5. Select a destination track to paste data.  
All selected tracks’ lamps light up.  
function will no longer be effective.  
You can select only mono tracks as the destination of a  
copied or moved mono track. If you copied or moved  
adjacent odd-even tracks, you can select only adjacent  
odd-even tracks as the destination.  
1. When a new recording is made.  
2. When a new editing is executed (such as Copy & Paste, Move &  
Paste, Erase).  
3. While in the AUTO PUNCH ON mode, when the AUTO PUNCH  
IN point is passed in the PLAY (or RECORD) mode.  
4. When the power is momentarily switched off.  
5. When the program is changed.  
If you do not select any tracks, the data will be pasted  
back to the copy or move source track.  
6. Turn the JOG dial to enter the number of repeats  
(Repeat=**).  
6. When ejecting a removable SCSI disk that is the current drive..  
You can enter up to 99. However, this is automatically  
limited by the available recording space on the disk.  
That is, if the disk has enough free space, you can set up  
to 99 repeats. If the disk has only a small amount of free  
space, the JOG dial allows you to set a lower number of  
repeats.  
7. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
[Copy Paste] (or [Move Paste]) flashes and the duration  
of the pasted data appears as a negative number on the  
display. This number will count down as the paste  
operation proceeds.  
When the paste operation is complete, the flashing [Copy  
Paste] (or [Move Paste]) lights up continuously, and  
[COMPLETED !] is displayed.  
Note: If you try to execute the paste operation by pressing the  
EXECUTE/YES key when the disk has insufficient free space, [Over  
!] appears on the display and edit mode is cancelled. In this case,  
you need to delete unnecessary data or Programs. Refer to the  
following section, “Erase,” and to “Deleting a Program” on page 34  
for more information on erasing.  
8. Press the STOP button or the EXIT/NO key.  
The VR800 exits edit mode and displays the previous Time  
Base indication.  
9. Turn off the RECORD TRACK select key of the copy  
(or move) source track.  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Editing Tracks)  
Erase  
There are two methods for erasing data. Understand the difference between these methods before you use the  
Erase function.  
* If multiple Programs are set on the disk, first select the desired Program. Do not select another Program until  
you finish the erase operation.  
• Erasing a specified part of the data between ABS 0 and  
REC END  
• Erasing data from a specified point to REC END  
You may erase all data in the range from a specified point to  
REC END in the currently-selected Program. You can erase  
data on a mono real track or multiple real tracks. To erase  
data on an additional track, you need to move the data to a  
real track, then erase it.  
You may erase a specified part of the data between ABS 0  
and REC END (the end point of the recording) in the currently-  
selected Program. (The erased part is replaced with silence.)  
You can erase data on a mono real track or multiple real tracks.  
To erase data on an additional track, you need to move the  
data to a real track, then erase it. As shown below, the REC  
END point (the end point of recording) is not affected.  
The erased area is replaced with silence. As a result, the  
REMAIN time and space will increase. (You will have more  
recordable space on the disk.)  
When you erase all tracks’ data, the REC END point will move  
backward. However, if you erase data on a mono track or  
multiple tracks (but not all tracks), the REC END point may  
not be affected. (Refer to the note below.) After the erase  
operation, the REMAIN time and space will increase.  
REC END  
AUTO PUNCH OUT point  
AUTO PUNCH IN point  
AUTO PUNCH OUT point  
AUTO PUNCH IN point  
Any real track  
Any real track  
Any real track  
Any real track  
ERASE  
Silence  
ERASE  
Silence  
REC END  
ABS 0  
REC END  
ABS 0  
Note: If all real tracks contain data as shown below, erasing data on tracks 1 and 2 will not affect the position of REC END.  
On the other hand, if all Real tracks contain data as shown below, erasing data on tracks 3 - 8 will move up REC END to the  
end point of tracks 1 and 2.  
AUTO PUNCH OUT point  
AUTO PUNCH OUT point  
AUTO PUNCH IN point  
AUTO PUNCH IN point  
(REC END)  
(REC END)  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Real tracks  
Real tracks  
ABS 0  
ABS 0  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
ERASE  
ERASE  
ERASE  
ERASE  
ERASE  
ERASE  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Real tracks  
Real tracks  
ERASE  
ERASE  
REC END  
ABS 0  
REC END  
ABS 0  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Editing Tracks)  
Follow the steps below to erase data:  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The flashing [Erase] message lights up steadily, and  
[SURE ?] flashes.  
Store the erase start point (AUTO PUNCH IN point) and the  
erase end point (AUTO PUNCH OUT point).  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
SURE ?  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
Flashing  
Use the Preview function to check the stored edit points and  
adjust them if necessary.  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
To cancel the erase operation, press the STOP button or the EXIT/  
NO key while [SURE ?] flashes on the display.  
Specify a track to erase and execute the function.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key again.  
The VR800 starts erasing the data and [Erase ....] flashes.  
When the erase operation is completed, [COMPLETED !]  
lights up.  
Storing the edit points  
1. Refer to the “Storing and editing the locate points  
to the memory keys” section for information on  
storing the erase start and end points.  
5. Press the STOP button or the EXIT/NO key.  
The VR800 exits edit mode and displays the previous Time  
Base indication.  
Store the erase start point to the AUTO PUNCH IN key,  
and the end point to the AUTO PUNCH OUT key.  
To erase the data in its entirety from the tracks, you can also  
use the Program Delete function to erase the entire Program.  
In either case, you can expand the recordable area on the  
disk. Use either one of the erase operations to erase  
unnecessary data if the VR800 displays an alarm message  
indicating insufficientrecordable space forAuto Punch In/Out,  
Copy & Paste, or Move & Paste.  
• If you wish to erase the data from a specific point, store the REC  
END or later point as the erase end point. Refer to the <Note> for  
information on storing the REC END point.  
• See “Storing and editing the locate points to the memory keys” on  
page 48.  
• Refer to “Deleting a Program” on page 34 for more information  
on the Program Delete function.  
Checking and adjusting the edit points  
After you store the edit points, you can check them on the  
display by pressing the corresponding keys.  
You may also adjust the points.  
Undo/Redo Erase  
You can undo or redo the Erase operation.  
1. While the recorder section is stopped, press and  
hold down the SHIFT key and press the memory  
key for which you wish to check the edit point.  
You can preview “fade-out” at the AUTO PUNCH IN point  
and “fade-in” at AUTO PUNCH OUT point.  
To restore the data that existed before you erased it, press the  
UNDO/REDO key.  
To restore the data after you undo the Erase operation, press  
the UNDO/REDO key again.  
When you press the UNDO/REDO key, the VR800 will undo or  
redo the operation immediately, and display [Undo!] or [Redo !]  
and [COMPLETED !].  
2. Trim the edit point while previewing.  
•Refer to “Preview Function” on page 59 for more information.  
Note: The Undo/Redo function is effective only when the  
VR800 is stopped.  
Executing Erase  
Note: If you perform one of the following operations after  
you use the Copy & Paste or Move and Paste operation, the  
Undo/Redo function will no longer be effective.  
1. Press the RECORD TRACK select key of the track  
to erase to set it READY.  
You can select a mono track, multiple tracks, or all tracks.  
1. When a new recording is made.  
2. When a new editing is executed (such as Copy & Paste,  
Move & Paste, Erase).  
2. Press the EDIT key repeatedly until [Erase] flashes  
on the display.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
3. While in the AUTO PUNCH ON mode, when the AUTO  
PUNCH IN point is passed in the PLAY (or RECORD) mode.  
4. When the power is momentarily switched off.  
5. When the program is changed.  
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
6. When ejecting a removable SCSI disk that is the current drive.  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Editing Tracks)  
Track Exchange  
The Track Exchange function enables you to swap mono track data or multiple track data of the current Program  
between Real tracks and Additional tracks in units of single or multiple tracks.  
You can swap mono track data between Real tracks, Additional tracks, or between a Real track and an Additional  
track. You can swap multiple track data between eight Real tracks (1–8) and Additional tracks (9–16 or 17–24).  
Refer to the diagrams below for information on how data on the tracks can be moved using this function.  
The Track Exchange function also enables you to move Real track data to an empty Additional track (to empty  
the original Real track) so that you can use the Real track for a new recording. This capability lets you use tracks  
more flexibly.  
You need to move data on an Additional track back to a Real track to audition the data, since data on an  
Additional track cannot be played in real-time.  
You can also use this function when you wish to check the REC END point of an Additional track, as described in  
the “Erase” section.  
Swapping multiple track data between eight Real tracks  
and eight Additional tracks (9–16 or 17–24)  
Swapping mono track data between Real tracks, Addi-  
tional tracks, or between a Real track and an Additional  
track.  
Real Tracks 1-8  
Additional Tracks 9-16  
Additional Tracks 17-24  
Real Tracks 1-8  
Additional Tracks 9-16  
Additional Tracks 17-24  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Editing Tracks)  
Executing Track Exchange  
• Swapping mono track data between any two tracks  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the EDIT key  
repeatedly until [TRK Exchg] flashes on the display.  
Alternatively, you can press the EDIT key, then use the  
JOG dial.  
1. When [1-8] is flashing, turn the JOG dial.  
Turning the JOG dial allows you to select a mono  
track from [1], [2], [3], [4]........ [24] in the left column.  
The right column continues a mono track.  
For example, if you select [4] in the left column, the  
display indicates [4<>1], meaning you can swap data  
between tracks 4 and 1.  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
Flashing  
44.1kHz  
DIGITAL  
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
2. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The display shows the track selection.  
The current display shows that you can swap eight-track  
data between Real tracks 1-8 and Additional tracks 9-16.  
If you wish to select other tracks, follow the steps below.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Flashing  
2. To select a number in the right column, press  
the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or the F  
FWD button to move the flashing cursor to the  
right column, then use the JOG dial to select  
the desired number.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
3. Select the tracks to swap data.  
* When you swap data between mono tracks, the  
indications [4<>1] and [1<>4], for example, mean the  
same thing — swapping data between tracks 1 and 4.  
• Selecting Real tracks 1-8 and Additional tracks 17-24:  
1. Press the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or  
the F FWD button to move a flashing cursor on  
[1-8] (left) to [9-16](right).  
Note: If you select the same tracks for swapping mono  
track data, the setting is ignored. The VR800 will indicate  
[Select Err] for a short moment, then return to the previous  
display.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
[Exchange] lights up and the swapping operation is  
completed immediately.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
The VR800 indicates [COMPLETED !], then returns to the  
previous Time Base display.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to change flashing [9-16] to  
flashing [17-24].  
Data on the additional tracks, as it stands, cannot be played  
back or its REC END confirmed. To do this, the data must  
be temporarily moved to a real track.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
If the additional track data, which is longer than the real  
track (1~8) data is to be saved to DAT or adat, the longer  
time data must be replaced to the real track. Please refer to  
“Save/load” for details.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Synchronization)  
MIDI sync function  
The following are examples concerning general types of systems using MIDI related functions contained in the VR800.  
MIDI clock sync system  
By setting any desired meter at any desired point of the programmable tempo map contained in the VR800, and by  
output of a MIDI clock and song position pointer according to the setting, a hardware type MIDI sequencer can be  
synchronized as a MIDI clock slave. Consequently, in this system, the VR800 will be the master and the MIDI sequencer  
the slave.  
* Restore the default settings on VR800.  
* Check for the correct program and proper sampling frequency.  
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
MIDI clock & song position pointer  
METER  
OL  
-3  
-6  
-9  
-12  
-18  
-24  
-36  
-40  
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO  
PAGE SELECT  
1-8 ANALOG IN  
9-16 ADAT IN  
17-20 EFF RTN  
MIDI IN  
SETUP  
EQ/LO  
GAIN  
EQ/LO-MID  
GAIN  
EQ/HI-MID  
GAIN  
EQ/HI  
GAIN  
SELECTED EQ  
EQ ON  
EFF EDIT  
SYSTEM  
MIDI  
EFF1  
EFF2  
EQ LIBRARY  
EFF LIBRARY  
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS  
RECALL  
STORE  
RECALL  
STORE  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
MIDI Sequencer  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
SOLO  
ON  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
SOLO  
ON  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
KEY MODE  
ROUTING/  
PHASE  
PAIR/  
GROUP  
REC BUSS  
SOLO  
SCENE MEMORY  
RECALL STORE  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
MMC SEND  
CHANNEL/  
METER  
CH VIEW  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
MIDI OUT  
/-1  
+1/  
EXIT  
DATA  
+10  
0
+10  
+10  
0
+10  
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
0
0
0
-10  
-20  
0
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-30  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
ENTER  
-20  
-40  
-60  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
MIDI IN  
MIDI sound sources  
Connecting external equipment (Refer to connecting schematic)  
1. Connect the VR800 MIDI OUT to MIDI IN of the MIDI sequencer.  
2. Set the MIDI sequencer for "external sync mode (EXTERNAL SYNC) by MIDI clock."  
* Refer to the Owners Manual of the equipment in use for details.  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Synchronization)  
Setup of VR800  
1.Because the MIDI clock and song position pointer will be output from the VR800, set the SETUP mode "MIDI sync  
signal output setting" to "cLK."  
* Initial setting: cLK  
* Permissible setting: cLK (MIDI clock and song position pointer:"CLK")  
Mtc (MIDI time code: "MTC")  
oFF (No output of MIDI sync signal)  
* This item can be setup for each program.  
* The setting can be saved/loaded as song data.  
* This setting will be held even though power is switched OFF.  
# Refer to page "95", SETUP mode "MIDI sync signal output setting" for correct operating procedures.  
2.The meter in the desired bar can be set by "Time signature setting" of the SETUP mode.  
* Initial setting: 001 bar, 4/4 signature.  
* Permissible bar setting: 001~999  
* Permissible meter setting: 1/4, 2/4, 3/4, 4/4, 5/4, 1/8, 3/8, 5/8, 6/8, 7/8, 8/8, -- -- (Elimination of signature)  
* Permissible setting of maximum number of points: 64 points  
* This item can be set for each program.  
* The setting can be saved/loaded as song data.  
* This setting will be held even though power is switched OFF.  
# Refer to page "90", SETUP mode "Time Signature Setting" for operating procedure.  
3.Tempo in the desired bar can be set by "Tempo setting" of the SETUP mode.  
Tempo map is made in steps 2 and 3.  
* Initial setting: 001 bar, 1st meter, Tempo120.  
* Permissible bar setting: Follows the previous "Setup of the time signature."  
* Permissible signature setting: Follows the previous "Setup of the time signature."  
* Permissible setting of tempo: Quarter note=30~250 .... (Tempo elimination)  
* Permissible setting of maximum number of points: 64 points  
* This item can be set for each program.  
* The setting can be saved/loaded as song data.  
* This setting will be held even though power is switched OFF.  
# Refer to page "92", SETUP mode "Tempo Setting" for operating procedure.  
4.Set the SETUP mode "Metronome setting" to ON if click sound is to be output according to the setup tempo map.  
* Initial setting: oFF  
* Permissible setup item: oFF, on  
* This item can be set for each program.  
* The setting cannot be saved/loaded as song data.  
* This setting will be held even though power is switched OFF.  
# Refer to page "93", SETUP mode "Metronome setting" for operating procedure.  
5.Press the TIME BASE SEL key, and then change the time base display to BAR/BEAT/CLK.  
Confirming the MIDI clock sync  
During recording and at playback following the recording, the time base (BAR/BEAT/CLK) is displayed in accor  
dance to the setup tempo map, and the MIDI clock and song position pointer is also output.  
Confirm that the travel position (BAR/BEAT/CLK) of the VR800 and the travel position of the synchronized MIDI  
sequencer are matched.  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Synchronization)  
* If correct sync cannot be obtained, re-check the connections/cables and setting of both equipment.  
Note: In the VR800, the "ABS 0" position is set at "-002BAR/1BEAT /00CLK (default setting value)."  
This setting is made in consideration of the time required (it will not sync immediately) for a MIDI sequencer, etc. to enter into sync.  
As a result, if the VR800 is played back from ABS 0 (LOCATE ABS 0), sync will be completed by the time it reaches the first bar, and  
will thus synchronize from the head of the tune. A BAR value of -002BAR/1BEAT/00CLK can be setup in the range of -009 ~ -002.  
Please refer to “Time signature setting” in SETUP mode for details.  
Execution of recording  
Various ways of recording can be conducted while synchronizing the VR800 and the MIDI sequencer with the MIDI  
clock.  
MTC sync/MIDI machine control system  
The following will explain synchronization by the MTC (MIDI time code) output and the computer controlling system  
using MMC (MIDI machine control). In this system, the VR800 will be the master and the computer (with sequence  
software) will be the slave. The VR800 will attach any desired offset (time difference) against ABS time (absolute time)  
and output it as MTC in any desired frame rate.  
It can also carry out the proper operation upon receiving an MMC and Fostex System Exclusive Message from outside.  
In this case, because the VR800 can setup a DEVICE ID number by the SETUP mode "MIDI Device ID Setting" menu, a  
multiple number of VR800's can be separately controlled by changing the DEVICE ID numbers in the transmitted  
message from the computer. In regards to the corresponding content for MMC, refer to the "MMC list" on page "107"  
and on the Fostex System Exclusive Message, the "Fostex Exclusive List" on page "108."  
* Set VR800 in the initial state.  
* Confirm the program and sampling frequency of the digital mixer.  
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
MMC or Fostex System Exclusive Message  
MTC  
METER  
OL  
-3  
-6  
-9  
-12  
-18  
-24  
-36  
-40  
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO  
PAGE SELECT  
1-8 ANALOG IN  
9-16 ADAT IN  
17-20 EFF RTN  
SETUP  
EQ/LO  
GAIN  
EQ/LO-MID  
GAIN  
EQ/HI-MID  
GAIN  
EQ/HI  
GAIN  
SELECTED EQ  
EFF EDIT  
SYSTEM  
MIDI  
EFF1  
EFF2  
EQ ON  
EQ LIBRARY  
EFF LIBRARY  
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
FREQ  
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS  
RECALL  
STORE  
RECALL  
STORE  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
Computer  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
SOLO  
ON  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
SOLO  
ON  
EQ EDIT  
EQ EDIT  
KEY MODE  
ROUTING/  
PAIR/  
PHASE  
GROUP  
REC BUSS  
SOLO  
SCENE MEMORY  
RECALL STORE  
with MMC/MTC  
soft ware  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
SOLO  
MMC SEND  
CHANNEL/  
METER  
CH VIEW  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
/-1  
+1/  
EXIT  
DATA  
+10  
0
+10  
+10  
0
+10  
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
0
+10  
0
0
0
-10  
-20  
0
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-30  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
ENTER  
-20  
-20  
-40  
-60  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
MIDI IN  
MIDI  
MIDI sound sources  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Synchronization)  
Connecting to external equipment  
Connect the VR800 MIDI IN/OUT to the computer (with MIDI interface) MIDI IN/OUT (MMC/MTC complied  
sequence software is activated in the computer).  
Setup of external equipment  
Setup the following in the sequence software.  
* Set to MTC external sync mode (EXTERNAL SYNC).  
* Set for output of MMC.  
* Set to the desired MTC read out frame rate.  
* Set start time of the tune (which MTC time is to be the first bar). Refer to precaution in regards to MTC offset, farther on.  
# For details, refer to Owners Manual of the external equipment.  
Setup of VR800  
1.Because MTC will be output from VR800, set to "MTC" the SETUP mode "MIDI sync signal output setting."  
# Refer to page "95", SETUP mode "MIDI sync signal output setting" for operating procedure.  
2.Set a random offset time by the SETUP mode "MTC offset time setting."  
* Initial setting: 00H (Hour) 59M (Minute) 57S (Second) 00F (Frame) 00SF (Sub Frame)  
* Permissible setup time: 00H 00M 00S 00F 00SF ~ 23H 59M 59S 29F 99SF  
* This item can be set for each program.  
* The setting can be saved/loaded as song data.  
* This setting will be held even though power is switched OFF.  
# Refer to page "96", SETUP mode "MTC offset time setting" for operating procedure.  
3.In the SETUP mode "MTC offset mode setting," whether the MTC offset time setup in Step 2 should be output  
(ABS) at the ABS 00m 00s 00f 00sf position or at the 001BAR 1BEAT 00CLK (bar, signature) must be selected.  
* Initial setting: ABS  
* Permissible setup item: ABS, Bar  
* This item can be setup for each program.  
* The setting can be saved/loaded as song data.  
* This setting will be held even though power is switched OFF.  
# Refer to page "97", SETUP mode "MTC offset mode setting" for operating procedure.  
4.Setup to the same frame rate as that setup by the sequence software by "MTC Frame rate setting" of the SETUP  
mode.  
* Initial setting: 25 frames  
* Permissible setup of frame rate: 24, 25, 29.97nd, 29.97df, 30nd, 30df  
* This item can be setup for each program.  
* The setting can be saved/loaded as song data.  
* This setting will be held even though power is switched OFF.  
# Refer to page "96", SETUP mode "MTC Frame rate setting" for operating procedure and details.  
5.Set to the same figure as the sequence software MMC device number (and Fostex System Exclusive Message  
device number) by the SETUP mode "MIDI device ID setting."  
When the sequence software transmits by "7F," it means "ALL DEVICE" and therefore, it need not be setup.  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Synchronization)  
* Initial setting: 00  
* Permissible setup ID: 00 ~ 99  
* This item will be the setting common to all programs.  
* This setting cannot be saved/loaded as song data.  
* This setting will be held even though power is switched OFF.  
# Refer to page "104", SETUP mode "MIDI device ID setting" for operating procedure and details.  
6.Press the TIME BASE SEL key to show time base in the MTC display.  
<Notes on MTC related setups>  
By "MTC offset time setting" and "MTC offset mode setting," at what position (ABS 0 or 001BAR/1BEAT/00CLK) should the setup MTC  
(MTC offset time) is to be output is set. When setting the start time of the tune in the sequence software by these setups, be careful of the  
following points.  
* Offset mode: For ABS  
If playback is started from ABS 0, since MTC will be output starting from the MTC offset time that has been set, the start time of the tune  
set by the sequence software must be set about 3 seconds later from the MTC offset time that was setup. This will provide time because  
the sequence software cannot sync immediately after MTC is output. For example, if the initial setting of 00H 59M 57S 00F 00SF" is  
used, set the start time of the tune to "01H 00M 00S 00F." If playback is thus started from ABS 0 (LOCATE ABS 0), sync will be obtained  
by the time it reaches the first bar and therefore it can be made to sync from the head of the tune.  
* Offset mode: For BAR/BEAT  
As mentioned before, because the "ABS 0" position is set at the "-002BAR / 1BEAT / 00CLK" (default value) position, the setup MTC  
offset time can be set to the head of the tune without taking into account the time until reaching sync, as mentioned above. The length of  
the time two bars beforehand will change in accordance to the first bar setting for "signature" and "tempo." For example, it will be long if  
the tempo is set slow. This mode can be effectively applied when using the MIDI clock and MTC in parallel, and when using MTC for the  
sync signal while controlling the VR800 with time base BAR/BEAT/CLK.  
Confirming MTC sync/MMC  
1.During recording and at playback after recording, time base MTC is displayed according to the setting and MTC  
is output at the same time.  
Check that the VR800 traveling position (MTC) and the traveling position of the sequence software in sync are matched.  
2.Send MMC commands such as PLAY, STOP and LOCATE from the sequence software to see that the VR800 will  
be properly controlled.  
When a correct MIDI command (MMC or FEX) is received, "MIDI" in the display will be lit for about 40msec. There is no setting  
in the VR800 to receive MMC or FEX but it will operate if a correct MIDI signal is input.  
* If sync and control cannot be done correctly, re-check connections/cables and the setting of both equipment.  
Execution of recording  
Carry out various recordings while synchronizing a VR800 and a MIDI sequencer with the MIDI clock.  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Synchronization)  
External MIDI equipment sync system by the slave mode  
Up to this point, synchronization with external MIDI equipment has been explained with the VR800 as the master and  
MIDI equipment as the slave but depending on the slave mode setting, the MIDI equipment can be set as the master and  
VR800 as the slave.  
<Note>  
External MIDI equipment which can be used as the master is limited to those which can output MTC.  
* Initialize VR800.  
* Confirm the program and sampling frequency.  
* In the following, the explanation will be on the assumption that a computer (with sequence software) is used.  
MIDI IN  
MIDI OUT  
OPTICAL  
ACCESS  
OL  
0
6
12  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC  
RECORD TRACK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Computer  
with MMC/MTC  
soft ware  
AUTO RTN  
CLIPBOARD  
EXIT  
EXECUTE  
AUTO PUNCH  
/
NO  
/
YES  
START  
IN  
OUT  
END  
IN  
OUT  
PREVIEW  
EJECT  
HOLD/  
STORE  
EDIT  
UNDO  
/
REDO  
DISP SEL  
SETUP  
PGM SEL  
AUTO RTN  
AUTO PLAY  
JOG  
SHUTTLE  
VARI PITCH  
LOCATE  
TIME BASE SEL  
SCRUB  
SHIFT  
P
.EDIT  
LOC MEM  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REW  
F
FWD  
CLIPBOARD PLAY  
LOCATE ABS  
LOCATE REC END  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
0
MASTER  
SLAVE  
Connection to external equipment  
Connect MIDI OUT of the computer (with MIDI interface) with MIDI IN of VR800. The computer sequence software  
complying to MMC/MTC must be activated.  
Setup of external equipment  
Sequence software is setup as follows.  
* Set for output of MTC.  
* Set frame rate of the MTC to be output.  
* Confirm start time of the tune.  
# Refer to Owners Manual of the respective equipment for details.  
Setup of VR800  
1.Set to same frame rate as the sequence software by the SETUP mode "MTC Frame rate setting."  
# Refer to page "96", SETUP mode "MTC Frame rate setting" for operating procedure and details.  
2.Set to the desired mode by the SETUP mode "MTC offset mode setting."  
# Refer to page "97", SETUP mode "MTC offset mode setting" for operating procedure and details.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Synchronization)  
3.A random offset time can be set by the SETUP mode "MTC offset time setting."  
# Refer to page "96", SETUP mode "MTC offset time setting" for operating procedure and details.  
4.Set slave mode to "On" by the SETUP mode "Slave mode setting," and the slave type to "Vari" by the SETUP  
mode "Slave mode type setting."  
# Refer to page "98", SETUP mode " Slave mode setting" , and page "99", SETUP mode "Slave mode type setting", for  
operating procedure and details.  
5.Press the TIME BASE SEL key to change the time base display to MTC.  
<Precautions at MTC related setups>  
The position (ABS 0 or 001BAR/1BEAT/00CLK) when the setup MTC (MTC offset time) should be output was setup by the "MTC offset time setting"  
and "MTC offset mode setting." In accordance to start time of the tune set by the sequence software, setup as explained below.  
Offset mode: For ABS  
Set the MTC offset time about three seconds prior to the start time of the tune set by the sequence software. Because the VR800 cannot  
immediately chase lock after input of MTC, in order to sync the VR800 from head of the tune, set the preroll using the sequence software, and  
playback from before the actual head of the tune to allow the VR800 to enter into sync by the time it arrives at the head of the tune.  
Offset mode: For BAR/BEAT  
The MTC offset time can be set to the same time as the start time of the tune set by the sequence software. Because the "ABS 0" position is set at  
the "-002BAR/1BEAT/00CLK" (default value) position in the VR800, as mentioned before, the preceding time required for sync is already set. The  
preceding time of two bar lengths could change in length depending on the first bar's "signature setting" and "tempo setting" mentioned before. For  
example, it will be longer if the tempo is slowed down.  
Confirming chase lock  
1.When the sequence software is played, “MTC” of the VR800 will light, “SLAVE” in the display will change  
from blinking to lit and the chase lock will be completed.  
Check that the MTC output by the sequence software and MTC time displayed in the VR800 are the same.  
2.When the sequence software stops, MTC will be interrupted and the VR800 will also stop.  
"SLAVE" in the display will change from lit to blinking.  
3.During FF/REW of the sequence software, VR800 will remain stopped but upon starting to record, the VR800 will  
immediately chase lock.  
<Note>  
Chase lock of the VR800 by MTC only is permissible when speed difference of the MTC from the master is within +/- 5.6%. Against the MTC within  
this range, variable pitch will be constantly applied internally for chasing. Chase lock, however, will not function against MTC at a speed difference  
outside this range. Also, when the master speed difference is large, it is advised to let VR800 learn the master speed by entering PLAY prior to  
recording. By doing so, it will be lock faster from the second and later sessions.  
* Should it not be possible to chase lock, re-check connections / cables and all settings.  
Execution of recording  
Carry out various recordings while the VR800 is chase locked to the sequence software.  
<One Point Advice>  
Sync signal "Free" of the "Slave mode setting" menu:  
When the VR800 is made to chase lock by MTC only, variable pitch will be constantly applied by external MTC. If a digital signal is output to an external  
digital equipment from the VR800, it will not be able to follow the speed difference (MTC speed difference of the master) of the VR800 and the external  
digital equipment, in some cases, may not be able to input a continuous digital signal.  
As a counter measure, the sync signal should be set to "Free" by the "Slave mode setting" menu. Using this setting, the VR800 will enter self operation  
by the internal clock, after completion of chase lock, and it will be possible to supply a stable digital signal to the external equipment.  
Under this setting, when MTC drift between the master unit and slave unit exceeds 10 frames, the VR800 will assume that chase lock has been  
disengaged and the slave unit will carry out position matching again with the master unit (re-chase operation). During the re-chase operation, sound  
output will be muted and the digital signal will also be interrupted. If it is within 10 frames, the slave unit will continue to run while admitting this drift.  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
Saving and Loading Song Data  
Outline of the save/load operation  
The VR800 has a Save/Load function for song data, which enables you to save the recorded song data (including  
SETUP data) to a connected backup media, such as a DAT machine, back-up SCSI disk or adat. You can also load  
the saved data from a DAT, back-up SCSI disk or adat to the current drive disk in the VR800. You can save and  
load one Program at a time to and from a DAT, adat, or SCSI drive.  
The following diagram shows different methods (depending on the current drive type) for saving data to con-  
nected media, and how to load data to the VR800. Select the appropriate connections depending on the type of  
connected media.  
Using a SCSI drive as the current drive:  
Note: You can save and load data between two SCSI drives,  
regardless of the recording mode used for the disks.  
When saving a multiple number of program data in one disk,  
they must definitely be of the same format.  
Back-up drive  
SCSI drive-2  
Current drive  
SCSI drive-1  
SCSI  
VR800  
Current Drive  
Note: You can save and load data to and from a DAT or adat  
only if the current drive is a SCSI fixed disk and it has been  
formatted in Master 8ch mode. You cannot perform the save/  
load operation if the disk has been formatted in Master 4ch mode  
or ADAC 8ch mode. (However, only in the case of save/load by  
DAT, the master 4ch mode disk can also be used.)  
SCSI drive  
DATA IN  
DATA OUT  
DAT  
adat  
The connection should follow one of these cases:  
* Transferring data between SCSI drive-1 and SCSI drive-2  
* Transferring data between SCSI drive-1 and a DAT (See “Note.”)  
* Transferring data between SCSI drive-1 and an adat (See “Note.”)  
Note: Be sure to set the ID number for a backup SCSI drive to  
“6.”  
Using an 3.5-inch internal E-IDE hard disk as the current drive:  
Back-up drive  
Note: You can save and load data to and from a DAT or adat only  
when the current drive has been formatted in Master 8ch mode. You  
cannot perform the save/load operation if the disk has been formatted  
in Master 4ch mode or ADAC 8ch mode. However, you can save and  
load data to and from a SCSI drive, regardless of the recording mode  
used for the disk.  
SCSI  
SCSI drive  
VR800  
Current Drive  
3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk  
DATA IN  
DAT  
adat  
DATA OUT  
Note: If you are using an 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk as the current drive,  
you can connect only a SCSI backup disk to the SCSI terminal on the  
VR800 (the ID number should be set to “6.”). If you connect a SCSI drive  
disk set up as a current drive disk (the ID is set to any number other than  
“6”) and you turn on the power to the drive, the VR800 will recognize this  
SCSI drive as the current drive.  
The connection should follow one of these cases:  
* Transferring data between a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk and a SCSI drive  
* Transferring data between a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk and a DAT (See “Note.”)  
* Transferring data between a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk and an adat (See “Note.”)  
<Notes on connection>  
If the connected DAT (preferably a professional model) features sync operation with external clock and its “INPUT (or EXTERNAL  
SYNC)” sync mode switch is set to OPTICAL, trying to load data with both digital I/Os connected as shown in the diagram may  
cause a digital clock loop to form and loading may fail.  
In this case, set the sync mode of the DAT to INTERNAL, or disconnect the optical cable from the DATA OUT of the VR800 before  
loading data. This type of problem will not occur during the save operation since the DATA IN connector of the VR800 is not  
effective.  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
<Notes on DAT machines and the save and load operations>  
You may use a DAT machine that can record digital data in S/P DIF format without compression in 16bit/44.1kHz mode.  
You cannot use media that uses a compression recording technique, such as an MD or DCC, media that automatically adjust the  
space between songs, such as a CD-R, media that converts sampling rate, or via Adat optical connectors. You can use media  
that features SCMS (Serial Copy Management System) if it satisfies the requirements described above.  
The following DAT models have been confirmed to operate with the VR800. Basically, any DAT machine that has digital in/out  
connectors in S/P DIF format will work for the save and load operation. However, some models (except those listed below) may  
cause errors.  
Fostex: D-5, Pioneer: D-05  
The save and load operations using a SCSI drive, DAT, or adat are described below:  
* Using a DAT (S/P DIF digital signal) (Saving/loading individual Program data: only in Master 8ch mode and Master  
4ch mode)  
Following about five seconds of pilot signal (shown in gray in the diagram below), song data in the current drive is  
output to a connected DAT. Two tracks of audio data (shown in black in the diagram) are output. To save data from  
Real tracks 1–8, two-track data will be output four times, which takes twice as much time as the song duration (ABS  
0 to REC END). To save all data including Additional tracks 9–24, two-track data will be output twelve times, which  
takes twelve times the song duration. Saved data is also loaded two tracks at a time.  
DAT tape  
Trk 23&24  
Trk 3&4  
Trk 21&22  
Trk 1&2  
Current drive disk  
Program 1 (P01)  
Program 2 (P02)  
Program 99 (P99)  
* Using an adat (adat digital signal) (Saving/loading individual Program data: only in Master 8ch mode)  
After about five seconds of pilot signal (shown in gray in the diagram below), song data in the current drive is output  
to a connected adat. Eight-track audio data (shown in black in the diagram) is output. To save the data from Real  
tracks 1–8, data will be output once, which takes the same amount of time as the song duration (ABS 0 to REC END).  
To save all data including Additional tracks 9–24, eight-track data will be output three times, which takes three times  
the song duration. Saved data is also loaded eight tracks at a time.  
Trk 17 & 18  
& 19 & 20  
& 21 & 22  
& 23 & 24  
Trk 9 & 10  
& 11 & 12  
& 13 & 14  
& 15 & 16  
Trk 1 & 2 &  
3 & 4 & 5 &  
6 & 7 & 8  
adat tape  
Current drive disk  
Program 2 (P02)  
Program 1 (P01)  
Program 99 (P99)  
* Using a SCSI disk (Saving/loading individual Program data: in any mode)  
All Real track data and Additional track data is output simultaneously to a SCSI disk as shown in black in the  
diagram. Therefore, saving and loading a Program takes much less time relative to a DAT or adat. No pilot signal or  
beep is recorded. If the available disk space is smaller than the song data size, you may use multiple disks (up to 99  
disks) to save and load an entire song.  
Trk 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 & 6 &7  
& 8 & 9 & 10 & 11 & 12 & 13  
& 14 & 15 & 16 & 17 & 18 &  
19 & 20 & 21 & 23 & 24  
SCSI disk  
Current drive disk  
Program 2 (P02)  
Program 1 (P01)  
Program 99 (P99)  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
<Note when saving data using DAT or adat>  
Refer to the following notes when you save all track data (real tracks and additional tracks) using a DAT or  
adat.  
The duration of the data that can be saved on the disk is calculated based on the duration of the song data  
(ABS 0 - REC END) on the real tracks. Therefore, if you try to save data on an additional track that is longer  
in duration than the data on the real track, only that part of the additional track (up to the same time  
indication of the real track) will be saved.  
For example, assume that you moved 10-minutes of data on a real track to an additional track (using the  
Track exchange function), then you recorded three minutes of data on the same real track.  
In this case, only three minutes of the additional track data will be saved. To reset (seven-minutes of data)  
will not be saved.  
If this happens, set the save time longer (up to 59 minutes and 59 seconds) using the save time editing  
procedure (see Step 6 on page 83). Alternatively, move the longest data on the additional track to a real  
track, then perform the save operation. At this time, be careful not to accidentally erase important data on  
the additional tracks. Refer to the page 66 for more information on the Track Exchange function.  
VR800  
Additional Tracks 9~24  
Save  
DAT or adat  
Real Tracks 1~8  
Only this range of data will be saved.  
REC END of the additional tracks  
REC END of the real tracks  
<Note when loading data using DAT or adat>  
Although the VR800 digital-in clock may be set in its initial state of [ASYnC] (asynchronous mode), when loading from DAT or adat, the  
digital-in clock of the VR800 will temporarily operate in the same way as if it is in [SYnC] (synchronous mode). In this case, because it will  
operate even though the [ASYnC] setting indicator “ ” is lit on the display, so care must be exercised not to create a digital clock loop.  
<Note when saving/loading data using adat>  
You may save data from the current drive to an adat as long as the current drive has been formatted in [Master 8ch] mode for eight-  
track simultaneous playback. You may also load data from an adat to the current drive if the drive was formatted in [Master 8ch] mode  
to enable 8-track simultaneous recording via the adat interface. Fostex will not guarantee operation of the VR800 if you use drives in  
other modes.  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
* The following items can be saved and loaded as song data:  
Memory data (CLIPBOARD IN/OUT, AUTO RTN START/END, AUTO PUNCH IN/OUT points)  
Time base (ABS, MTC, or BAR/BEAT/CLK)  
SETUP mode: * Time signature setting (BAR BEAT), * Tempo setting, * Preroll time setting, * MIDI sync out setting,  
* MTC frame rate setting, * MTC offset time setting, * MTC offset mode setting, * Rec protect On/Off setting,  
* Slave mode On/Off setting, * Slave type setting  
* The following items cannot be saved and loaded as song data:  
Auto Play mode and Auto Return mode On/Off setting  
Vari-pitch mode On/Off setting, and Pitch data  
SETUP mode: * Digital In setting, * Digital Out setting, * Bar/Beat Resolution On/Off setting, * Device ID setting * Click On/Off  
setting,  
Saving and loading data using a SCSI drive as the current drive  
If the current drive is a SCSI drive (removable disk or fixed disk), you can save and load data to and from a  
backup SCSI drive, DAT, or adat. If the backup drive is a SCSI drive, save and load operations are not limited by  
the type of recording mode used for the current drive. If you are using a DAT or adat as a backup drive and using  
a fixed disk as the current drive, the fixed current drive should be formatted in “Master 8ch mode” to enable  
saving and loading. However, only in the case of save/load by DAT, the “Master 4ch mode” disk can also be used.  
Saving/loading data using another SCSI drive  
This section explains how to save and load data to and from a removable current SCSI drive and a backup SCSI  
drive. Turn off the power to all connected devices before you make connections.  
Note: Unlike the save/load operation using a DAT or adat, you cannot abort the save/load operation that uses a SCSI drive. Nor  
can you monitor audio data during the operation. Also, you cannot load data to a disk formatted in a recording mode that differs  
from that on the backup disk. For example, you cannot load data from a backup disk in ADAC 8ch mode to a disk in Master 8ch  
mode.  
Load  
Save  
Current drive  
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
VR800  
Backup drive  
(ID number = “6”)  
SCSI drive connection and preparation  
* Connect your backup SCSI drive to the SCSI connector  
on the current SCSI drive. Be sure to attach a  
terminator on the second SCSI drive to terminate the  
SCSI chain.  
<Title of data to be saved to a backup SCSI disk>  
Data recorded in the current drive has a name, such as  
Program 1 or Program 2. (These titles appear abbreviated,  
such as [P01], [P02]).  
On the other hand, a backup disk manages data using dif-  
ferent titles, such as Backup 1 or Backup 2. (These appear  
abbreviated, such as [B01] or [B02] on the display.)  
For example, Program 1 (P01) on the current drive disk is  
saved as Backup 1 (B01) for the backup disk.  
* Be sure to set the ID number for the backup SCSI drive  
to “6.”  
* Prepare the disk recorded as the current drive and a  
backup disk (unformatted disk).  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
Saving data  
* You can back up data using the “Save PGM ?” menu in  
SETUP mode. The following procedure assumes that a  
recorded disk has been inserted in the current SCSI  
drive, Program 1 (P01) has been selected, and an  
unformatted disk will be used as the backup disk.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
MB  
REMAIN  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
<[Save PGM ?] menu>  
* Output signal options: [AdAt], [dAT], [SCSi id-6]  
When the formatting operation is completed,  
[COMPLETED !] lights up, [SCSi id-6] flashes, then the  
VR800 displays the following.  
* Program options:  
* Track options:  
P01 - P99 (an individual Program)  
When using an adat or DAT: tracks 1–8,  
tracks 1–16, Tracks 1–24;  
This example shows that the data to be saved is Program  
1 on the current drive. If the current drive has multiple  
Programs, use the JOG dial to select the desired Program.  
When using a SCSI disk: All tracks will be  
automatically selected.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
SETUP  
1. Insert an unformatted disk into the backup drive.  
MB  
2. Press the SETUP key to enter SETUP mode, then  
use the JOG dial to select [Save PGM ?] menu.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
5. Use the JOG dial to select the desired Program and  
press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
[Device ?] appears and the selected output signal option  
flashes. ([SCSi id-6] flashes.)  
The save operation starts and the following indication  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Flashing  
appears.  
This example shows that Program 1 data is being saved  
as Backup data 1. As the save operation progresses, the  
REMAIN value (e.g.: -80MB) counts down.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
MB  
SETUP  
REMAIN  
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
When the save operation is completed, [COMPLETED!]  
lights up and the following indication appears.  
Normally, the initially displayed save device will be the  
flashing [SCSi id-6] as shown above.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
At this stage, if the JOG dial is rotated, besides the flash-  
ing [SCSi id-6], [dAT] or [AdAt] can be selected.  
[dAT] or [AdAt] is selected if either DAT or adat are used  
for saving.  
COMPLETED !  
Lights up  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
8. Press the EXIT/NO key to exit SETUP mode.  
The VR800 displays ABS 0 of the Program on the current  
drive.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 recognizes that a disk in the backup drive is  
unformatted, and displays [Unformat ?], then proceeds  
to the [Bk Format?] menu (backup disk format) in SETUP  
mode, then displays the following.  
Note: The backup data will use the number of the saved  
Program. (e.g., if you save P01 [#0001 data, the backup data  
will be named as B01[#0001.) You cannot edit the title of the  
backup data.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SURE?  
CLK  
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
The above procedure assumes that the saved data size is  
smaller than the available space of the backup disk. You can  
use only one backup disk. To save data larger than a single  
backup disk, refer to the next <Memo> for information on  
saving data using multiple backup disks.  
5. Press and hold down the RECORD button, and  
press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 displays the following and starts formatting  
the disk. The unformatted disk area size will count down  
as the format operation progresses.  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
<Memo>  
If Program data to be saved is larger than the space available on one backup disk, the VR800 tells you how many  
backup disks you need when you select a Program in Step 6 of the previous procedure.  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
44.1kHz  
(e.g.)  
(e.g.)  
Three backup disks are  
required.  
Two backup disks are  
required.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
When you set the first disk, the save operation starts. When the disk is full, the VR800 automatically ejects the disk  
and displays [Ins. Disk 2] (meaning “Please set the second disk.”).  
Set the second disk to continue the save operation.  
Note: Mark the disks so that you can identify the order of the disks and you will be able to insert the disks in  
the correct order to perform the load operation.  
Loading data  
Normally, the initially displayed load device is the flash-  
ing [SCSi id-6]. At this stage, if the JOG dial is rotated, in  
addition to the flashing [SCSi id-6], [dAT] or [AdAt] can  
be selected.  
* You can load data using the “Load PGM ?” menu in  
SETUP mode. The following procedure assumes that  
the backup disk has been inserted into the backup  
SCSI drive, and a formatted disk has been inserted  
into the current drive.  
[dAT] or [AdAt] is selected when DAT or adat is used for  
loading.  
<[Load PGM ?] menu>  
4. Select a flashing [SCSi id-6] and press the  
* Input signal options: [AdAt], [dAT], [SCSi id-6]  
* Program options:  
* Track options:  
P01 - P99 (an individual Program)  
When using an adat or DAT: tracks 1–8,  
tracks 1–16, Tracks 1–24;  
EXECUTE/YES key.  
The saved backup number (01) flashes. This means that  
B01 on the backup disk is selected to load.  
If only this backup file exists on the disk, turning the JOG  
dial will allow you to select [B01] or [Eject].  
Select [Eject] if you wish to change the disk.  
If there are multiple backup files on the disk, using the  
JOG dial allows you to select the desired backup data  
(B01, B02, B03, etc.) or [Eject].  
When using a SCSI disk: All tracks will be  
automatically selected.  
1. Press the SETUP key to enter SETUP mode, then  
use the JOG dial to select [Load PGM ?] menu.  
2. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
[Device ?] appears, and the selected input signal option  
flashes. ([SCSi id-6] flashes.)  
MB  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Flashing  
5. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
The VR800 indicates that the load destination disk (cur-  
rent drive disk) does not have any data, then indicates a  
flashing [SURE?].  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
At this time, using the JOG dial allows you to select the  
load destination Program.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Flashing  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
MB  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
SURE  
?
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
Since there is only one Program in the destination disk in  
7. Press the EXIT/NO key to exit SETUP mode.  
this example, you can select only [P01].  
If the destination disk contains multiple Programs, see  
the following <Memo>.  
The Time Base display of the loaded Program appears.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
6. Use the JOG dial to select the load destination  
Program and press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 starts loading data.  
COMPLETED !  
Lights up  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Backup data [B01] is loaded to Program [P01] on the cur  
rent disk. As the operation progresses, the REMAIN value  
counts down.  
8. Press the EJECT button on the backup drive to eject  
the backup disk.  
When the load operation is completed, [COMPLETED !]  
lights up.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
MB  
REMAIN  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
<Memo>  
<Memo>  
If you saved one Program to multiple backup disks, the  
VR800 indicates that the disk in the drive is the “first”  
disk, as follows:  
If the load destination disk contains multiple Programs,  
the VR800 asks whether you wish to set up a new Pro-  
gram in Step 6 of the procedure above. ([03] and [SURE ?]  
flash.) This is because the existing Programs may already  
contain data. If you do not mind overwriting the existing  
data with the loaded data, select the desired Program  
number as the load destination.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Flashing  
Confirm that this message appears, and execute the load  
operation. When data in the first disk is loaded, the VR800  
automatically ejects the disk and displays [Inst. Disk 2],  
meaning “Please insert the second disk.” Insert the sec-  
ond disk and continue the load operation.  
SURE  
?
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
In the above display example, the VR800 asks you if you wish  
to create a new Program 3, since Programs 1 and 2 on the  
current drive disk contain data.  
Note: Make sure that you insert the disks in the correct  
order. If you insert the wrong disk, the VR800 displays  
[Wrong disk] and ejects the disk. Follow the disk markings  
you made during the save operation.  
Saving/loading via a DAT or adat  
To use a DAT or adat to save and load data, the current SCSI drive disk should be a fixed disk that is formatted in  
“Master 8ch mode.” However, save/load only when using DAT is possible, and can also be used for the “Master  
4ch mode disk.”  
Refer to the “Saving/loading data using an 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk as the current drive” section for a detailed  
procedure of the save/load operation.  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
Saving/loading data using an 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk as the current drive  
If you are using an 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk as the current drive, you can save and load data to and from a DAT,  
adat, or backup SCSI drive disk.  
<Note on the save/load operation using an 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk>  
Before saving or loading data to/from the connected 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk, make sure that the [IDE] indicator is lit in  
the current drive section of the display. If a SCSI drive is also connected to the VR800 as the current drive, disconnect the  
SCSI drive, or turn off the SCSI drive, then turn on the VR800.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
ABS  
M
S
F
PGM  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
IDE  
[IDE] lights up  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Saving song data via a DAT or adat  
This section explains how to save data from an 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk (current drive) to a DAT or adat. You can  
simultaneously save two tracks of data from an individual Program to a DAT, or eight tracks to an adat. Be sure  
to turn off the power to the all devices before you make connections.  
Note: The current drive disk should be formatted in “Master 8ch mode” to enable you to save data to a DAT or adat.  
However, only the “Master 4ch mode” disk can be saved/loaded when using DAT.  
Save  
DAT or adat  
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
OPTICAL IN  
(or adat in)  
VR800 with a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk  
DAT (or adat) connection and preparation  
* Set the DAT or adat so that it will accept S/P DIF digital  
input (or adat digital input). Some models may have  
to be set so that they will synchronize with the  
incoming digital signal. Refer to the manual that came  
with your DAT or adat for more information.  
* Connect DATA OUT from the VR800 to the OPTICAL  
IN on a DAT, or to adat in on an adat using an optical  
cable. If you are using S/P DIF digital signal (DAT),  
use an optional Fostex COP-1 (optical–coaxial  
converter) to connect a DAT that is equipped with only  
a COAXIAL (RCA) digital input.  
* After all connections have been made, turn on the  
power to all devices, and insert a tape into a DAT (or  
adat). Make sure that the tape’s “write-protect tab” is  
closed so that it can be recorded, and that the tape is  
rewound to the beginning.  
Note: Depending on whether you use a DAT or an adat,  
you need to switch between S/P DIF digital signal (OPTI-  
CAL) and adat digital signal for the DATA IN/OUT jacks.  
These signals are completely different, although they use  
the same jack configuration.  
* Set the sampling frequency of a DAT (or adat) to the  
same value as the VR800 (44.1kHz).  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
Saving data  
* You can back up data using the “Save PGM ?” menu in  
SETUP mode.  
The following procedure assumes that Program 1 on  
the 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk (current drive) contains  
performance data.  
6. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The total time saved in the selected program will be shown  
in the display, and this time can then be edited.  
Normally, the displayed time is saved as it is. But, as men-  
tioned in <Notes when saving data using DAT or adat> on  
page 77, in cases where the data on the additional track is  
longer than that on the real track, the time to ve saved can  
be edited. However, time which can be edited has to be a  
maximum 59 minutes 59 seconds. This feature is also effec-  
tive for making a short save.  
<[Save PGM ?] menu>  
* Output signal options: [AdAt], [dAT], [SCSi id-6]  
* Program options: P01 - P99 (an individual Program)  
* Track options:  
When using an adat or DAT: tracks 1–8,  
tracks 1–16, Tracks 1–24;  
DIGITAL  
When using a SCSI disk (SCSi id-6): All tracks  
will be automatically selected.  
Flashing  
M
S
PGM  
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
1. Press the SETUP key to enter SETUP mode.  
2. Use the JOG dial to select [Save PGM ?] menu, then  
press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
To edit the time value, use the HOLD/> key, REWIND  
button, or F FWD button to move the flashing cursor to  
the desired digit, and turn the JOG dial to change the  
value. (The above example shows you can edit the minute  
value.)  
[Device ?] appears and the selected output signal option  
flashes. ([SCSi id-6] flashes.)  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
SETUP  
7. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
The VR800 displays the track selection screen.  
First, Real tracks 1–8 appear. Turn the JOG dial to change  
number “8” to the desired number.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Flashing  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
Flashing  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
3. Use the JOG dial to select the desired digital signal  
for the save operation ([dAT] or [AdAt]).  
8. Use the JOG dial to select the desired tracks.  
Options are Tr 1–8, Tr 1–16 (Real track 1–8 and  
Additional track 9–16), or Tr 1–24 (Real track 1–8 and  
Additional track 9–24).  
Select this to save data in the adat digital signal  
format to a connected adat.  
[AdAt]  
Select this to save data in the S/P DIF digital signal  
format to a connected DAT.  
[dAT]  
9. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The display changes as follows.  
This means “Start recording on the DAT (or adat)!”  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The number of the Program selected before the VR800  
entered SETUP mode flashes on the display, indicating  
that you can select a Program to save.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Flashing  
SURE  
?
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
SETUP  
Flashing  
PGM  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
10. Start recording on the DAT (or adat).  
At this time you could set a START-ID or a locate point at  
the recording start point so that you will be able to find  
the top of the Program to load later.  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
5. Use the JOG dial to select a Program to save.  
If multiple Programs exists in the current drive disk, turn  
the JOG dial to change the Program number.  
11. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 starts saving data and displays the total time  
required for the save operation. The time value starts  
counting down a few seconds later.  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
Before the value starts counting down, the VR800 is  
transmitting a pilot signal that will be a reference of the  
tape position during the load operation.  
A DAT records two tracks at a time. An adat records  
eight tracks at a time.  
Level meters 1 and 2 indicate the level of signal output to  
a DAT. Level meters 1–8 indicate the level of signal  
output to an adat. When the save operation is completed,  
[COMPLETED !] lights up and the VR800 stops.  
Stop recording on the DAT (or adat).  
Actual data recording starts when the count down starts.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
REMAIN  
H
M
S
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
12. Press the EXIT/NO key or the STOP button.  
The VR800 exits SETUP mode and [COMPLETED !]  
disappears. The VR800 displays the Time Base (ABS 00M  
00S 00F) of the saved Program.  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
This area shows which tracks are  
currently being saved. During the  
save operation to the DAT, it indi-  
cates tracks 1–2, then changes to  
3–4, 5–6, etc. in two-track steps.  
During the save operation to adat,  
it indicates tracks 1–8, then 9–16,  
and 17–24, according to the track  
selection in Step 8.  
This value represents the to-  
tal duration of the Program  
being saved, and counts  
down as the save operation  
progresses.  
Loading song data via a DAT or adat  
This section explains how to load backup data from a DAT or adat to a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk (current drive).  
You can load two-tracks of individual Program data from the DAT simultaneously, or eight tracks of data from  
the adat.  
This procedure assumes that no recordings exist on the current drive (load destination). Be sure to turn off the  
power to all devices before you make connections.  
Note: The current drive disk should be formatted in “Master 8ch mode” to load data to or from a DAT or adat.  
However, loading from DAT only is also possible in the “Master 4ch mode” disk.  
Load  
DAT or adat  
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
OPTICAL OUT  
(or adat out)  
VR800 with a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk.  
DAT (or adat) connection and preparation  
* Connect the DATA IN on the VR800 to the OPTICAL  
OUT on a DAT or to “adat out” on an adat using an  
optical cable. If you are using S/P DIF digital signal  
(DAT), use an optional Fostex COP-1 (optical–coaxial  
converter) to connect a DAT that is equipped only with  
a COAXIAL (RCA) digital output.  
Note: Depending on whether you use a DAT or an adat,  
you need to switch between S/P DIF digital signal (OPTI-  
CAL) and adat digital signal for the DATAIN/OUT jacks. These  
signals are completely different, although they use the same  
jack configuration.  
* After all connections are made, turn on the power to  
all devices, and insert a backup tape into a DAT (or  
adat). Rewind the tape to a point slightly before the  
beginning of the saved data.  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
Loading data  
* You can load data using the “Load PGM ?” menu in  
SETUP mode. The following procedure assumes that  
the current drive disk (3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk) does  
not contain any recordings, and that Program 1 (P01)  
has been set up on the disk.  
6. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 displays the track selection screen.  
You can change the value of a flashing number.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
<[Load PGM ?] menu>  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
* Input signal options: [AdAt], [dAT], [SCSi id-6]  
* Program options: P01 - P99 (an individual Program)  
7. Use the JOG dial to select the desired tracks.  
Options are Tr 1–8, Tr 1–16 (Real track 1–8 and  
Additional track 9–16), or Tr 1–24 (Real track 1–8 and  
Additional track 9–24). In this example, select Tr 1–8.  
* Track options:  
When using an adat or DAT: tracks 1–8,  
tracks 1–16, Tracks 1–24;  
When using a SCSI disk (SCSi id-6): All tracks  
will be automatically selected.  
8. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 enters “load standby” mode and displays the  
following. [SURE ?] flashes.  
1. Press the SETUP key to enter SETUP mode.  
2. Use the JOG dial to select [Load PGM ?] menu,  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Lights up  
then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
[Device ?] appears and the selected input signal option  
flashes. ([SCSi id-6] flashes.)  
SURE  
?
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Flashing  
Flashing [DIGITAL] indicates that signal is not input from the  
digital device (DAT or adat) correctly. Check the connections.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Note: Althoogh the [ASYnC] (Asynchronous mode) indicator  
may be kit in the display, during loading, the VR800 will operate  
in the [SYnC] (Synchronous mode). Be careful of making a digi-  
tal loop which can be created by the digital in clock.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Flashing  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
9. Make sure that [DIGITAL] lights up steadily, and  
press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 displays the following, indicating “Start  
playing the DAT!” If you are using an adat, [Play AdAt]  
flashes.  
3. Use the JOG dial to select the desired type of  
digital signal used for the load operation ([dAT] or  
[AdAt]).  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Flashing  
SETUP  
Select this to load data in the adat digital signal  
[AdAt]  
format from a connected adat.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
Select this to save data in the S/P DIF digital signal  
format from a connected DAT.  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
[dAT]  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The number of the Program set up on the current drive  
flashes on the display.  
10. Start playing the DAT (or adat).  
Start playing the tape from a point slightly prior to the  
top of the Program data. The VR800 reads the recorded  
pilot signal, then automatically starts loading data. (Wait  
a while until thefollowing indication appears.)  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Flashing  
PGM  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
REMAIN  
H
M
S
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
5. Use the JOG dial to select a Program into which to  
load data.  
If only one Program has been set up, turning the JOG dial  
enables you to select [01] or [02]. If you select [02], “PGM”  
of [Load PGM] and [New] flash alternately.  
This means that a new Program (P02) should be set up  
before you execute the load operation. (If multiple  
Programs exist in the current drive disk, turn the JOG  
dial to select a Program from these Programs plus one  
new Program.)  
The VR800 displays the track numbers being loaded and  
the total time of the Program. The time value starts  
counting down as the load operation progresses.  
The RECORD TRACK select key lamps for tracks 1 and 2  
flash,and level meters 1 and 2 indicate the level of signal  
input from the DAT. (All RECORD TRACK select lamps  
flash and level meters 1–8 indicate the level of signal  
input from an adat.)  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
When the load operation is completed, [COMPLETED !]  
lights up. The VR800 displays the top of the Program in  
the current drive and stops.  
11. Stop playing the DAT (or adat).  
12. Press the EXIT/NO key or the STOP button.  
[COMPLETED !] disappears.  
Saving and loading song data via a SCSI drive  
This section explains how to save and load data to and from a SCSI backup drive and a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk.  
Recording mode on the current drive does not affect this operation. Refer to the “Saving and loading song data  
between two SCSI drives” for more information on the procedure.  
Connect a SCSI backup drive (ID #=6) to the SCSI connector on the 3.5-inch hard disk in the VR800, as shown below.  
<Note on connections>  
Be sure to connect a SCSI backup drive to the SCSI connector. Make sure that the ID number for the SCSI backup  
drive is set to “6.”  
Load  
Save  
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
SCSI backup drive  
(ID# = 6)  
VR800 with a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk  
Note: As shown in the drawing, when the SCSI drive assigned for the current drive is daisy chained to the SCSI drive for  
backup and also connected to an 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk which is in the current drive mode, please note the following items.  
Current SCSI drive  
Backup SCSI drive  
DATA  
OUT  
MIDI  
WORD OUT SCSI  
IN  
OUT  
IN  
AC IN  
POWER  
OPTICAL  
VR800 with a 3.5 inch E-IDE hard disk  
When the 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk is assigned as the current drive:  
Switch on power to VR800 only and not to the two SCSI drives connected.  
If save/load of song data is to be executed using the SCSI drive assigned for backup, switch on power to the VR800 and the  
SCSI drive assigned for backup. Do not switch on power to the SCSI drive assigned for the current drive. By utilizing either  
method, VR800 will always recognaize the 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk as the current drive.  
In order to use the SCSI drive as the current drive, power to any equipment that is interconnected must, of course, be  
switched on. The SCSI drive will automatically switch to the current drive mode.  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Saving and Loading Song Data)  
<Quick Troubleshooting>  
If you are stuck in one of the following situations, refer to the explanations below for corrective actions.  
The VR800 recognizes that the backup disk cannot be used  
in its current condition. There are two reasons for this.  
# The VR800 displays the following during the save  
operation using a SCSI backup drive:  
Flashing  
* You inserted a disk that was used for the current drive.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
* The disk’s recording mode differs from that of the data  
to save or load.  
SETUP  
For example, the disk used to save or load data in Master  
8ch mode is inserted to save data in ADAC 8ch mode.  
That is, you tried to use a disk (that was once used to  
save or load data in a particular recording mode) to save  
data in a different recording mode.  
SURE  
?
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
The backup disk contains some data and does not have  
enough free space to record new data. The VR800 is  
asking you whether or not the existing data should be  
deleted. Take one of the following actions:  
Backup drive  
Current drive  
save  
load  
data recorded inADAC 8ch  
mode  
dsik in ADAC 8ch mode  
* If you wish to delete the existing data:  
Press the EXECUTE/YES key twice. Pressing the key once  
causes [Del. ALL ?] and [SURE ?] to flash, and pressing it  
again deletes the existing data so that you will be able  
to continue the save operation.  
Current drive  
Backup drive  
save  
* If you do not wish to delete the existing data:  
Turn the JOG dial to display [Eject], then press the EX-  
ECUTE/YES key. The disk will be ejected. Insert another  
backup disk in the drive.  
disk used to save/load data  
in ADAC 8ch mode  
disk in Master 8ch mode  
To be able to use the ejected disk, you need to re-format  
it as described below.  
# When you inserted a SCSI backup disk into the  
backup drive to save data, the following messages  
appeared in turn and the disk was ejected.  
* Quit SETUP mode and return to the Time Base display  
of the current disk, then insert the disk in the backup  
drive.  
* Select the [Bk Format ?] menu in SETUP mode and re-  
format the backup disk.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
Note: When saving a multiple number of program data to  
one disk, they must be in the same format.  
Should data of different format be mixed and saved, the situ-  
ation above will occur.  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
IDE  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Changing the Initial Settings (SETUP Mode)  
SETUP mode of the VR800 offers the “Changing the initial settings” menus that configure the operating environment  
of the VR800, a “Check” menu that enables you to check the number of events of each track, and the “Execution”  
menus that execute certain operations, such as save and load.  
The “Changing the initial settings” menus include 15 parameters as shown in Table-1 below. These parameters  
were set before the unit was shipped from the factory (These values are called the “initial settings.”). Modifying  
these settings allows you to change the operating environment of the VR800.  
The “Check” menu provides one parameter “Checking the number of events” as shown in Table-2.  
Also, as shown in Table-3, the “Execution” menus include six items: Title Edit?, Delete. PGM?, Load PGM?, Save  
PGM?, and Disk Format?, which you can execute by selecting the corresponding SETUP menu. This chapter  
explains how to use the “Changing the initial settings” menus shown in Table-1 and the “Check” menu shown in  
Table-2. For more information on the “Execution” menus, refer to the corresponding pages in the “Reference  
page” column in Table-3.  
<Table-1> “Changing the initial settings” menu  
Parameters  
Display  
Default setting  
001BAR 4/4  
Refer page  
90  
Community  
Setting a time signature  
Signature Set ?  
Setting a Tempo  
Setting the metronome function  
Tempo Map Set ?  
001BAR 1 120  
oFF  
92  
93  
Click  
?
Setting a preroll time  
Preroll Time ?  
MIDI Sync OUT ?  
Frame Rate ?  
MTC OFFSET  
Offset Mode ?  
Slave Mode ?  
00  
94  
95  
96  
Setting MIDI sync output signal  
Setting an MTC frame rate  
Setting an MTC offset value  
Setting Offset mode  
cLk (Clock)  
25 frame  
00H 59M 57S 00F 00SF 96  
ABS  
oFF  
97  
98  
Setting the slave mode  
Setting the slave type  
Slave Type ?  
Rec Protect ?  
VAri  
oFF  
99  
Setting the record protect function  
100  
Setting digital input tracks  
Setting digital output tracks  
Digi in ?  
Digi out ?  
AdAt, ASYnC  
AdAt  
101  
102  
Setting BAR/BEAT resolution mode  
Setting the MIDI device ID number  
Resolution ?  
Device ID ?  
oFF  
00  
103  
104  
Modes applicable program by program. They can be saved/loaded.  
Modes applicable to all programs. They cannot be seved/loaded.  
<Table-2> “Check” menu  
Check item  
Display  
Refer page  
105  
Community  
-
Check of the Event number on the track.  
NOs Of Event ?  
<Table-3> “Execution” menu  
Execution item  
Display  
Delete PGM ?  
Title Edit PGM ?  
Save PGM ?  
Load PGM ?  
Format ?  
Refer page  
Community  
Deleting a Program  
34  
35  
75  
75  
27  
30  
-
-
-
-
-
-
Editing a Program title  
Saving song data to an external digital device  
Loading song data from an external digital device  
Formatting an current drive disk  
Formatting a back-up drive disk  
Bk Format ?  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Selecting SETUP mode  
Follow the steps below to select the desired SETUP menu in SETUP mode.  
This lights up when the VR800  
enters SETUP mode.  
The title of the SETUP menu  
appears. You can select a different  
menu via the JOG dial.  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
on the control panel.  
Pressing the SETUP key causes the VR800 to enter SETUP  
mode. The VR800 displays the first hierarchy level of  
the SETUP menu you selected before you turned off the  
power. At this time, the menu graphics appear as shown  
below.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
The flashing menu indicator is the currently-selected  
menu. Turning the JOG dial will select a different menu  
and the corresponding menu indicator will flash.  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
This indicates the position of the SETUP menu. Selecting a  
menu via the JOG dial will move the flashing cursor.  
2. Select the desired menu using the JOG dial, then  
press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The VR800 displays the second hierarchy level of the  
selected SETUP menu, where you can set parameters.  
(Refer to the next page for more information.)  
To exit SETUP mode, press the STOP button or the EXIT/  
NO key. Each time you press one of these keys, the VR800  
returns to the previous hierarchy level of the menu, and  
finally exits SETUP mode.  
Note: With the factory initial settings, or when you turn on the  
power again after you format an external SCSI disk, “Sign. Set?  
(Setting a time signature)” appears. Otherwise, the first hierarchy  
level of the previously-selected SETUP menu appears.  
The following diagram shows the position of each menu.  
Tempo Set ?” menu  
“Del PGM ?” menu  
“Click ?” menu  
“Preroll ?” menu  
“Sync Out ?” menu  
“Sign. Set ?” menu “Title Edit ?” menu  
“Frame Rate ?” menu  
“Mtc Offset ?” menu  
“Ofset Mode ?” menu  
“Slave Mode?” menu  
“Slave Type?” menu  
“Bk Format ?” menu  
“Format ?” menu  
“Rec Protect ?” menu  
“Digi. in ?” menu  
“Digi. out ?” menu  
Resolu ?” menu  
“Save PGM ?” menu  
“Load PGM ?” menu  
“NOs Event ?” menu  
“Device ID ?” menu  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Setting a time signature (“Sign. Set ?” menu)  
Using the “Setting a time signature” menu, you can set a time signature of a given measure on the internal  
programmable Tempo Map. And also in this setting, the BAR (-002BAR, 1 , 00CLK) displayed at the head of the  
disk in the time base BAR/BEAT/CLK can be set within the range of -009BAR ~ -002BAR.  
For example, you can specify “4/4 for the first and second measures, and 2/4 from the third measure.” Setting  
a time signature and tempo will create a Tempo Map, which allows the VR800 to manage a song using the BAR/  
BEAT/CLK Time Base. You can also use the Metronome function.  
A time signature and tempo setting are required when MIDI clock & Song Position Pointer are output to an  
external sequencer.  
• Initial setting: [4 4] for bar [001] (not specified for 002 and later.)  
• Setting range of measures: [001] - [999]  
• Setting range of BAR: [-009BAR] - [-002BAR]  
• Setting range of time signatures: [1 4], [2 4], [3 4], [4 4], [5 4], [1 8], [3 8], [5 8], [6 8], [7 8], [8 8], [- -] (delete)  
• Max. setting points: 64 points  
* You can set time signatures for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
Storing a time signature  
Rotate the JOG dial to enter the desired measure number.  
If you wish to keep the initial setting for the first measure,  
enter 002. If you try to enter any number other than  
001, the time signature indicator shows [- -]. This means  
that no time signature is set for any measures other than  
the first measure. To change the time signature for the  
first measure, follow the steps below, without entering  
any other measure number.  
1. Select a Program for which to set a time signature.  
Refer to “Using the Program Change function” on page  
34 for information on selecting a Program.  
2. Press the SETUP key, use the JOG dial to select the  
[Sign.Set ?] menu, then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The indication changes to [Sign. Chk] and the current  
time signature appears. The initial setting is [001BAR 4  
4] (4/4 for the first measure).  
Press the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or the F FWD  
button to display flashing [—] of [- -] and enter the time  
signature using the JOG dial.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
The following measure numbers and time signatures can  
be entered via the JOG dial.  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
001-999, selection of [All Clear?]  
indication.  
BAR  
[All Clear?] means that data in its entirety  
will be cleared. This is used to initialize  
Measures  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
the parameter. (Refer to “Clearing stored  
time signature/tempo data.”)  
At this time, rotating the JOG dial clockwise enables you  
to check the current time signatures in sequence.  
With the initial setting, time signatures after the first  
measure are all [---BAR- -]. This means that a time  
signature of 4/4 applies to all measures.  
1 4, 2 4, 3 4, 4 4, 5 4, 1 8, 3 8, 5 8,  
6 8, 7 8, 8 8, - -  
[- -] means no time signature assigned,  
and is used to delete time signature data.  
(Refer to “Modifying (or deleting) stored  
time signatures” for more information.)  
Time signatures  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The indication changes to [Sign. Edit] and [001 (measure)]  
of [001BAR 4 4] flashes. You can enter any time signature  
here.  
Note: You cannot assign “- -” to measure 001.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key whenever you enter  
a pair of measure/time signature values.  
Repeat this step to specify the necessary time signature  
for the measures.  
SETUP  
BAR  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
To cancel the setting operation, or to exit SETUP mode  
after storing data, press the STOP button or the EXIT/  
NO key. Each time you press one of these keys, the  
VR800 returns to the previous hierarchy level of the  
menu, and finally exits SETUP mode.  
Modifying (or deleting) stored time signatures  
1. Repeat steps 1-3 described in the “Storing a time  
Caution: If modifying or deleting the stored time signature  
signature” section to display [Sign. Edit].  
causes the bar/beat setting for the tempo specified in the  
“Setting a tempo” menu to disappear, the tempo setting will  
also be automatically erased.  
2. Press the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or the  
F FWD button so that the flashing cursor is on the  
time signature value.  
To cancel the setting operation, or to exit SETUP mode  
after storing data, press the STOP button or the EXIT/NO  
key. Each time you press one of these keys, the VR800  
returns to the previous hierarchy level of the menu, and  
finally exits SETUP mode.  
3. Use the JOG dial to enter a new value.  
Entering [—] deletes the existing data.  
Note that you cannot enter [—] for measure 001.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
Clearing all time signature and tempo settings  
To cancel the All Clear operation, press the STOP button  
Caution: Using this function will erase not only the time  
signature setting but also the tempo data specified in the  
“Setting a tempo” menu described in the next section.  
or the EXIT/NO key now. Each time you press one of  
these keys, the VR800 returns to the previous hierarchy  
level of the menu, and finally exits SETUP mode.  
1. Repeat steps 1-3 described in the “Storing a time  
signature” section to display [Sign. Edit].  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The stored time signature and tempo data in its entirety  
are cleared, and the initial settings are restored.  
2. While the measure number is flashing, turn the JOG  
dial counter-clockwise to select [All Clear ?].  
When [All Clear ?] appears, [SURE ?] flashes, and you can  
clear the time signature and tempo data in the next step.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SURE  
?
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Changing the BAR at ABS “0” of the time base  
BAR in -002BAR/1 /00CLK, which indicates the head figure of the disk in the time base BAR/BEAT/CLK, can be changed.  
Although the initial figure is -002BAR, this can be set within the range of -009BAR ~ -002BAR.  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
[2] in [-002BAR] will flash and the bar figure can be  
changed with the JOG dial (Numbers that can be input  
are 2~9.)  
1. Repeat steps 1-2 described in the “Storing a time  
signature” section to display [Sign. Chk].  
2. Turn the JOG dial counter-clockwise to select [-002  
BAR OFFSET].  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
When the JOG dial is rotated to extreme left [-002BAR  
OFFSET], as shown below will appear (-002BAR is the initial  
setup figure).  
BAR  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
BAR  
4. Use the JOG dial to enter a new value.  
5. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Setting a tempo (“Tempo Set ?” menu)  
The “Setting a tempo” menu enables you to specify a tempo at a given point in a song that already has a time  
signature setting. For example, you can specify a tempo of 150 to the third beat of the 12th measure.  
Time signature and tempo settings make a Tempo Map, which is used by the VR800 to manage the song using the  
BAR/BEAT/CLK Time Base, and enable the Metronome function. Tempo settings as well as time signature settings  
are required when you wish to output MIDI clock and Song Position Pointer to an external sequencer.  
• Initial setting: bar 001, beat 1 : 120 (001BAR 1 120TEMPO)  
• Setting range of measures  
• Setting range of beats  
• Setting range of tempo  
• Max. setting points  
: Determined by the time signature setting.  
: Determined by the time signature setting.  
: 30-250/quarter note, --- (delete)  
: 64 points  
* You can set the tempo for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
Checking the stored tempo setting  
1. Select a Program to check the tempo setting for.  
Press the SETUP key, use the JOG dial to select the [Tempo  
Set ?] menu, then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
2. Rotate the JOG dial clockwise.  
You can view the current tempo values in sequence.  
Tempo value [- - - BAR - TEMPO - - -] means that no  
tempo values are specified after the current setting.  
With the initial setting, [001 BAR 1 TEMPO 120] is  
followed by [- - - BAR - TEMPO - - -].  
Indication on the display changes as shown below, and  
the current tempo appears. The initial setting is [001  
BAR 1 TEMPO 120]. This means that a tempo for the first  
beat of the first measure is set to 120.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
BAR  
TEMPO  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Storing a tempo value  
3. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
Pressing the HOLD/> key or the F FWD button repeatedly  
will move the flashing cursor from TEMPO to BAR and to  
, then returns to TEMPO.  
The display indicates [Tempo Edit] and [TEMPO] flashes.  
(See the figure below.)  
This means that you can enter a value now.  
Pressing the REWIND button repeatedly will move the  
cursor in the opposite direction.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
The bar and beat settings for the time signatures  
determine the setting range of bar and beat settings for  
the tempo. You can specify a tempo between 30 and 250  
per quarter note.  
SETUP  
BAR  
flashes  
TEMPO  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
The indication [---] means “no tempo,” which is used to  
delete a tempo setting.  
4. Press the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or the  
F FWD button to move the flashing cursor to the desired  
edit location, and use the JOG dial to enter the bar/  
beat/tempo information to be stored.  
When you turn the JOG dial, [---] appears for the bars  
and beats for which no tempo has been set.  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
4
4
5. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The display shows the stored bar/beat/tempo, then  
returns to the Tempo Edit indication (as shown in step  
4).  
Tempo=90  
Tempo=120  
6. Repeat steps 3-5 to store necessary tempo data.  
For example, if you specify tempo values in the song with  
[001 BAR 4 4] and [005 BAR 3 4] settings, the Tempo  
Map includes the settings shown in the table below.  
3
4
Tempo=60  
Tempo=120  
Tempo Map  
Time signature setting  
Tempo setting  
001 BAR 1 TEMPO 120  
003 BAR 1 TEMPO 90  
001 BAR 4  
005 BAR 3  
4
4
005 BAR 3 TEMPO 60  
007 BAR 2 TEMPO 120  
Modifying (or deleting) stored tempo settings  
1. Repeat steps 1-3 described in the “Storing a tempo  
value” section to display [Tempo Edit ?].  
4. Use the JOG dial to enter a new value.  
Entering [---] deletes the data at the selected bar/beat.  
2. Press the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or the  
F FWD button so that the flashing cursor is on the  
measure number. Turn the JOG dial to select bar/  
beat to edit or delete.  
5. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
6. Press the STOP button or the EXIT/NO key  
repeatedly to exit SETUP mode.  
3. Press the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or the  
F FWD button so that the flashing cursor is on the  
TEMPO number.  
Setting the Metronome function (“Click ?” menu)  
“Setting the Metronome function” menu allows you to determine whether or not the VR800 outputs a metronome  
sound from Real track 8 during playback or recording. Turning the Metronome function on enables you to  
record your performance while playing the instrument accompanying the metronome sound.  
Note: Since Real track 8 outputs the metronome sound when this function is turned on, you cannot play the audio recorded on this track.  
Also, do not record any data on track 8.  
The VR800 can output the metronome sound even from an unrecorded area (outside of the range from ABS 0 to REC END) on track 8.  
• Initial setting  
• Option  
: [oFF]  
: [oFF], or [on]  
* You can turn the function on and off for each Program individually.  
* The settings cannot be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
Setting the Metronome function  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
flashes  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Click ?] ([?] flashes.),  
then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
The current setting ([oFF] or [on]) appears on the display.  
Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key lights up the flashing [?]  
character steadily; the current setting flashes. The initial  
setting is [oFF] as shown below.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
3. Turn the JOG dial to select [on] or [oFF].  
Selecting [on] will enable the output of the metronome  
sound. Selecting [oFF] (initial setting) will disable the  
metronome output.  
To cancel the setting operation, or to restore a setting  
obtained prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press the  
STOP button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you press  
one of these keys, the VR800 returns to the previous  
hierarchy level of the menu, and finally exits SETUP mode  
and displays the previous Time Base.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The display shows the selection (on or oFF), then returns  
to the indication in step 2.  
Setting a preroll value (“Preroll ?” menu)  
The VR800 features the Preroll function that enables you to locate a position a few seconds prior to a specified  
locate point. The “Setting a preroll value” menu allows you to set the preroll time (in seconds).  
The Preroll function is convenient when you wish to monitor the audio data from a point slightly before the  
locate point.  
• Initial setting  
: [00] second  
• Setting range of preroll time : [00]-[10] seconds in one second steps  
* You can set the value for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
Preroll time (before the locate point) can be set between 00 and 10 seconds.  
This point is located if the current position is before  
the locate point.  
This point is located if the current position is after the locate point.  
Locate point (stored in the memory key)  
This point is actually located.  
Setting a preroll time  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
3. Turn the JOG dial to enter a desired preroll time  
value.  
You can set a value in one-second increments.  
Rotating the JOG dial clockwise increases the value, and  
rotating it counter-clockwise decreases the value.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Preroll ?] ([?] flashes.),  
then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The current preroll time setting appears on the display.  
Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key lights up the flashing [?]  
character steadily; the current setting flashes. The initial  
setting is [00] as shown below.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The display shows the value, then returns to the  
indication that appeared in step 2.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
To cancel the setting operation, or to restore the setting  
obtained prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press the  
STOP button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you press  
one of these keys, the VR800 returns to the previous  
hierarchy level of the menu, and finally exits SETUP mode  
and displays the previous Time Base.  
S
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
S
SYNC OUT  
DRIVE  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Setting MIDI sync output signal (“Sync Out ?” menu)  
The “Setting MIDI sync output signal” menu enables you to select the type of MIDI sync signals output from the  
MIDI OUT connector on the rear panel of the VR800 to an external MIDI device.  
The options are MIDI clock & Song Position Pointer, or MTC (MIDI time code). Select an appropriate option  
depending on the type of signal supported by the connected MIDI device.  
If you select MIDI clock & Song Position Pointer, first you need to set the time signatures and tempo as described  
previously. If you select MTC, you first need to set the MTC frame rate, the MTC offset time, and the MTC offset  
mode as described later.  
• Initial setting : [cLK] (clock & Song Position Pointer)  
• Option  
: [cLK] (clock & Song Position Pointer), [Mtc] (MIDI time code), [oFF] (no output)  
* You can set the parameters for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
Setting MIDI sync signal  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
Each option appears on the display as follows.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
When [cLK] is selected:  
2. Rotate the JOG dial to select [Sync Out ?] ([?]  
flashes.), then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The currently-selected MIDI sync signal type appears on  
the display.  
SYNC OUT  
When [Mtc] is selected:  
MTC  
SYNC OUT  
When [oFF] is selected:  
Press the EXECUTE/YES key to turn off the flashing [?]  
indication. The MIDI sync signal type indication flashes,  
and the indicator flashes indicating the SYNC OUT setting.  
The initial setting is [cLk] as shown below.  
To cancel the setting operation, or to restore a setting  
obtained prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press the  
STOP button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you press  
one of these keys, the VR800 returns to the previous  
hierarchy level of the menu, and finally exits SETUP mode  
and displays the previous Time Base.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
flashes  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
3. Turn the JOG dial to select the desired MIDI sync  
signal.  
Setting this parameter to [cLK] (initial setting) will select  
MIDI clock & Song Position Pointer.  
Setting the parameter to [Mtc] will select MIDI time code.  
With the [oFF] setting, no MIDI sync signal will be output.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The selected MIDI sync signal type is stored, and the  
VR800 returns to the display with the flashing [?] indicator  
as shown in step 2.  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Setting an MTC frame rate (“Frame Rate ?” menu)  
The “Setting an MTC frame rate” menu enables you to set the frame rate for MTC output from the MIDI OUT  
connector of the VR800 to an external MIDI device. If you have already set the type of MIDI sync output signal to  
[MTC], you need to set the frame rate. Use the frame rate of MTC received by the external MIDI device (or  
sequence software).  
• Initial setting  
: [25 F] (25 frames)  
• Setting range of frame rate : [24 F], [25 F], [30 DF], [30 F]  
* You can set the value for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
Setting an MTC frame rate  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
3. Turn the JOG dial to enter the desired frame rate.  
Rotating the JOG dial clockwise or counter-clockwise  
displays available frame rates as an alternative.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Frame Rate (?)] ([e] and  
[?] flash alternately.), then press the EXECUTE/YES  
key.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The selected frame rate is stored and the display returns  
to the indication with a flashing [?] that appeared in step  
2.  
The current frame rate setting appears on the display.  
Press the EXECUTE/YES key to turn off the flashing [?]  
character; the current setting flashes. The initial setting  
of [25 F] flashes as shown below.  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting obtained  
prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press the STOP  
button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you press one of  
these keys, the VR800 returns to the previous hierarchy  
level of the menu, and finally exits SETUP mode and  
displays the previous Time Base.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
F
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
F
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Setting an MTC offset value (“Mtc Offset ?” menu)  
The “Setting an MTC offset value” menu enables you to specify an offset time value - the difference between the  
time of MTC output from the VR800 and the ABS 00M 00S 00F 00SF time. You need to specify this value if you  
have selected [Mtc] for the “Setting MIDI sync output signal” menu.  
With the initial setting of 00H 59M 57S 00F 00SF, for example, MTC of 59M 57S 00F 00SF is output at the ABS time  
00M 00S 00F 00SF. You can also set an offset value from the 001 BAR 1 00 CLK value (bar/beat) on the Tempo  
Map. Refer to the next section for information on MTC Offset mode.  
• Initial setting  
: [00H: 59M: 57S: 00F: 00SF]  
• Setting range of offset time : 00H: 00M: 00S: 00F: 00SF - 23H: 59M: 59S: 29F: 99SF  
* You can set the value for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Setting an MTC offset  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
3. Use the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or the  
F FWD button to move the flashing cursor, and turn  
the JOG dial to enter the desired offset value.  
Press the HOLD/> key or the F FWD button to move the  
flashing cursor to the right, and press the REWIND button  
to move it to the left. Turning the JOG dial continuously  
will round up the number to the next digit.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Mtc Offset (?)] ([t] and  
[?] flash alternately.), then press the EXECUTE/YES  
key.  
The current offset value appears on the display.  
Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key turns off the flashing [?]  
character, and the value in seconds flashes.  
You can enter a value at the flashing digit. The number  
[57] of the initial setting [57S] flashes as shown below.  
For example, if you rotate the JOG dial on the seconds  
digit up 59, turning the dial further will increase the  
number on the digit of minute by one.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The selected offset value is stored and the display returns  
to the indication with the flashing [?] that appeared in  
step 2.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
MTC OFFSET  
SETUP  
F
flashes  
H
M
S
SF  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting obtained  
prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press the STOP  
button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you press one of  
these keys, the VR800 returns to the previous hierarchy  
level of the menu, and finally exits SETUP mode and  
displays the previous Time Base.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
MTC OFFSET  
SETUP  
F
flashes  
H
M
S
SF  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Note: For example, if you set MTC Offset mode to [ABS] (see the  
next section) and you wish to start the song from MTC’s 01H 00M  
00S 00F, you may wish to set a preroll of three seconds with an  
MTC offset of 00H 59M 57S 00F.  
Setting Offset mode (“Ofset Mode ?” menu)  
If you have selected [MTC] in the “Setting Offset mode” menu, you need to select MTC Offset mode.  
This menu enables you to determine whether the specified MTC is output at ABS 00H 00M 00S 00F or at 001 BAR  
1
00 CLK (bar/beat) of the Tempo Map.  
Note: As an example, if you set MTC Offset mode to [ABS] and you wish to start the song from MTC’s 1H 00M 00S 00F, you may want to set  
a preroll of three seconds with MTC offset of 00H 59M 57S 00F.  
If you select [BAR ] as the MTC Offset mode, a preroll of two measures is automatically set. Use 01H 00M 00S 00F; do not set a preroll value.  
Note: If you set Offset mode to [BAR ] and use MTC to synchronize sequence software on the computer, the tempo of the sequencer may  
sometimes slip gradually. This is because the tempo of the VR800 and the tempo of the software are slightly different even if both use the  
same tempo. Some sequence software can read the tempo output from the VR800 correctly. We recommend that you use the tempo of the  
VR800 on the sequence software. No such problems will occur if the sequence software synchronizes the VR800 via MIDI clock, instead of  
MTC.  
• Initial setting  
: [ABS 00H 00M 00S 00F]  
• Offset mode option : [ABS 00H 00M 00S 00F], or [BAR 001 BAR 1  
]
* You can set the mode for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Setting MTC Offset mode  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
3. Use the JOG dial to select the desired Offset mode.  
Rotating the JOG dial clockwise or counter-clockwise will  
alternately show a flashing [ABS 00H 00M 00S 00F] and  
[001BAR 1 ].  
If you select [ABS 00H 00M 00S 00F], the specified MTC  
offset time is output at ABS 00H 00M 00S 00F.  
If you select [001BAR 1 ], the specified MTC offset time  
is output at 001 BAR 1 00 CLK of the Tempo Map.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Offset Mode (?)] ([e]  
and [?] flash alternately.), then press the EXECUTE/  
YES key.  
The current offset mode appears on the display.  
Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key to turn off the flashing [?]  
character. The Offset mode indicator flashes.  
With the initial setting, [ABS 00H 00M 00S 00F] flashes as  
shown below.  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
F
SETUP  
BAR  
ABS  
H
M
S
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
ABS  
H
M
S
F
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
The selected offset mode is stored and the display returns  
to the indication with flashing [e] and [?].  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting obtained  
prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press the STOP  
button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you press one of  
these keys, the VR800 returns to the previous hierarchy  
level of the menu, and finally exits SETUP mode and  
displays the previous Time Base.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
F
ABS  
H
M
S
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Setting the Slave mode (“Slave Mode ?” menu)  
The “Setting the Slave mode” menu allows you to set Slave mode of the VR800 to on and off.  
When Slave mode is turned on, the VR800 will lock to MTC input from the master device.  
With this menu setting, you can set up a system in which multiple VR800s operate in sync or an VR800 synchronizes  
to a Fostex digital multitrack recorder, as well as the VR800 locking to MTC output from the sequence software.  
• Initial setting  
• Option  
: [o FF]  
: [on] or [o FF]  
* You can set the mode for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
* The Program is automatically checked before the operation.  
* The sampling rate is automatically checked before the operation.  
Turning Slave mode on and off  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
flashes  
SETUP  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Slave Mode (?)] ([e] and  
[?] flash alternately), then press the EXECUTE/YES  
key.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
44.1kHz  
DRIVE  
The current slave mode appears on the display.  
Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key turns off the flashing [?]  
character, and the Slave mode indicator flashes.  
With the initial setting, [o FF] flashes as shown below.  
DIGITAL  
SETUP  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
After you set Slave mode to [on], you need to select the  
3. Use the JOG dial to turn Slave mode on and off.  
Slave type (type of sync signal) described in the next section.  
Rotating the JOG dial clockwise and counter-clockwise  
alternates flashing [on] and [oFF].  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SLAVE  
SETUP  
lights up  
Selecting [on] turns Slave mode on, and selecting [oFF]  
turns Slave mode off.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
If you select [oFF], [e] and [?] flash alternately.  
If you select [on], [e] and [?] flash alternately and [SLAVE]  
flashes as shown below.  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting obtained  
prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press the STOP  
button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you press one of  
these keys, the VR800 returns to the previous hierarchy  
level of the menu, and finally exits SETUP mode and  
displays the previous Time Base.  
This means that the VR800 has not locked to the sync  
signal. When the VR800 locks to the sync signal from the  
master device, [SLAVE] lights up steadily.  
Setting the Slave type (“Slave Type ?” menu)  
The “Setting the Slave type” menu enables you to setup how VR800 should function after chase lock, when  
VR800 is set to sync externally in “slave mode ON” by the previously mentioned “Setting the slave mode.”  
• Initial setting : [VAri]  
• Option  
: [VA ri], [Fr EE]  
[VA ri]: The VR800 synchronizes only to external MTC.  
[Fr EE]: The VR800 locks to MTC, then synchronizes to the internal clock.  
* You can set the parameter for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
* The Program is automatically checked before the operation.  
* The sampling rate is automatically checked before the operation.  
Setting the Slave type  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
Rotating the JOG dial clockwise and counter-clockwise  
will cause the [VA ri] and [Fr EE] indicators to flash in  
sequence.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Slave Type (?)] ([e] and [?]  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flash alternately), then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The current Slave type appears on the display.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
SCSI  
Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key turns off the flashing [?]  
character, and the Slave type indicator flashes.  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
With the initial setting, [VA ri] flashes as shown below.  
<Notes>  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
flashes  
SETUP  
• You need to input MTC from an external device to the VR800 with  
any Slave type.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
• The VR800 re-chase window is fixed to ten frames. That is, if an  
offset between the master device and slave device exceeds ten  
frames, the VR800 interprets that as out of sync, and tries to chase  
and lock to MTC sent from the master device. (This operation is  
called “re-chasing.”) During the re-chase operation, audio output  
is muted. If the slave machine slips with MTC from the master  
device by less than ten frames, the slave machine continues  
running while recognizing the slippage.  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
• When you set the Slave type, the Vari Pitch function is automatically  
disabled. (The [VARI PITCH] indicator turns off.)  
3. Use the JOG dial to select the desired Slave type.  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The selected Slave type is stored, and [e] and [?] flash  
alternately.  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting obtained  
prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press the STOP  
button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you press one of  
these keys, the VR800 returns to the previous hierarchy  
level of the menu, and finally exits SETUP mode and  
displays the previous Time Base.  
Setting the Record Protect function (“Rec Protect ?” menu)  
The VR800 features the Record Protect function, which is similar to the function of record-protect tabs on cassette  
tapes. The “Setting the Record Protect function” menu allows you to turn the Record Protect function on and off.  
When this function is turned on, you cannot record, paste, or erase data. Use this function to protect your  
precious data from being erased accidentally.  
• Initial setting  
• Option  
: [o FF]  
: [on] or [o FF]  
* You can turn the function on and off for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
* The Program is automatically checked before the operation.  
Recording enabled/disabled  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
3. Use the JOG dial to enable or disable recording.  
Rotating the JOG dial clockwise and counter-clockwise  
will flash [on] and [o FF] alternately.  
Selecting [o FF] enables recording; you can record, paste,  
and erase data.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Rec Protct (?)] ([t] and  
[?] flash alternately), then press the EXECUTE/YES  
Selecting [on] disables recording; and you cannot record,  
paste, or erase data.  
key.  
The current setting appears on the display.  
Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key turns off the flashing [?]  
character, and the recording enabled/disabled indicator  
flashes. With the initial setting, [o FF] flashes as shown  
below.  
Note: When recording is disabled (on) and you try to record,  
paste, or erase data, the VR800 displays [Protected] for a second,  
indicating that you cannot perform the operation. To perform the  
operation, you need to enable recording (oFF).  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
[t] and [?] flash alternately.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting  
obtained prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press  
the STOP button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you  
press one of these keys, the VR800 returns to the  
previous hierarchy level of the menu, and finally exits  
SETUP mode and displays the previous Time Base.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Setting digital input tracks (“Digi. In ?” menu)  
The “Setting a digital input track” menu enables you to assign digital signals (adat digital signal or S/P DIF digital  
signal) input at the DATA IN connector on the VR800 to tracks. It also enables you to make the digital-in clock  
setting. Typically, the digital input track is set to [AdAt] (adat digital signal), assuming that a digital mixer with  
adat I/O is connected to the VR800. Channels 1-8 are routed to tracks 1-8. Digital-in clock is set to “ASYnC  
(asynchronous).” You may assign digital input tracks to any two tracks (S/P DIF digital signals) or set digital-in  
clock to “SYnC (synchronous).”  
• Initial setting  
: AdAT ASYnC (Asynchronous)  
: L channel = AdAT, 1 ~ 8  
: R channel = 1 ~ 8  
• Assignable tracks  
• Setting digital-in clock  
: ASYnC (Asynchronous)  
: SYnC (Synchronous)  
* This setting is shared by all Programs in the same disk.  
* The settings cannot be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
Setting digital input tracks  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
4. Turn the JOG dial to select a track with a flashing  
channel number. To change a flashing number, use  
the HOLD/> key, REW button, or F FWD button.  
Turning the JOG dial while [L*] is flashing enables you to  
select from channels 1-8 and AdAt. Turning the JOG dial  
while [r*] is flashing enables you to select from channels  
1-8.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Digi. in ?] ([?] flash  
alternately), then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
When you select [Digi. in ?], the VR800 displays the current  
digital input track and digital-in clock settings. When you  
press the EXECUTE/YES key, the flashing [?] disappears  
and the digital input track indication starts to flash.  
With the default setting, [AdAt] starts flashing and [ASYnC]  
lights up as shown below.  
Note: You cannot assign L channel and R channel to the  
same track. If you assign the same track and press the  
EXECUTE/YES key, the last channel you set will have  
priority, and the first channel will be automatically set to [-].  
For example, if you assign L channel to [2], then assign R  
channel to [2], and press the EXECUTE/YES key, L channel  
will be set to [L-], and R channel will be set to [r-2].  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
5. After you select a track to assign, press the  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
EXECUTE/YES key.  
flashes  
The selected track will be registered, and the display  
shown in step 2 appears.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
When a digital signal that matches the digital input track  
setting is input, [DIGITAL] lights up on the display. If the  
signal is different than the setting (for example, if S/P  
DIF signal is input while the digital input track is set to  
[AdAt]) the [DIGITAL] indicator will flash.  
3. While the [AdAt] is flashing, turn the JOG dial.  
When you turn the JOG dial, the flashing [AdAt] indicator  
changes to the S/P DIF digital input track indication.  
Note: If [DIGITAL] flashes on the display, check the  
connection with the external device, and the settings on  
the VR800 and the external device.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting  
obtained prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press  
the STOP button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you  
press one of these keys, the VR800 returns to the  
previous hierarchy level of the menu, and finally exits  
SETUP mode and displays the previous Time Base.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Setting a clock of digital in  
1. While the digital input track setting ([AdAt], [*L], or  
[r*]) is flashing, press the HOLD/> key, REW button,  
or F FWD button so that [A SYnC] will flash.  
The “ ” indicator will also flash.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [ASYnC] or [SYnC].  
In [A SYnC] mode, the system does not synchronize the  
digital-in clock. In [SYnC] mode, the system synchronizes  
the digital-in clock.  
3. After you select the clock, press the EXECUTE/YES  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
key.  
flashes  
The selected clock will be registered, and the display  
shown in step 2 appears.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Note: Set the digital-in clock and the digital mixer clock  
carefully if the VR800 is connected to a digital mixer. Refer  
to “Connecting a digital mixer” in the Quick Operation Guide.  
Setting digital output tracks (“Digi. Out ?” menu)  
The “Setting digital output tracks” menu enables you to assign the track that outputs digital signals from the  
DATA OUT connector of the VR800 to an external digital device. You can send the recorded audio data on the  
VR800 to an external digital device (MD, DAT, adat, digital mixer, etc.) in digital form. Any two tracks selected  
from tracks [1]–[8] are assignable. You can also select [AdAt] to output all track data (1–8) simultaneously to a  
digital device with an adat input.  
• Initial setting  
:AdAt  
• Assignable tracks: L channel = [AdAt], [1] ~ [8]  
R channel = [1] ~ [8]  
* This setting is shared by all Programs in the same disk.  
* The settings cannot be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
<IMPORTANT>  
Match the sampling rate of the digital input on the external device with  
the sampling rate of the VR800 to send digital signals from the VR800  
to the external device.  
Setting digital output tracks  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
flashes  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Digi. out ?] ([?] flashes),  
then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
The current digital output track assignment appears on  
the display.  
Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key turns off the flashing [?]  
character, and setting of the digital output track flashes.  
With the initial setting, [AdAt] flashes as shown below.  
You can select a flashing channel to assign a track.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
3. While the [AdAt] is flashing, turn the JOG dial.  
When you turn the JOG dial, the flashing [AdAt] indicator  
changes to the S/P DIF digital output track indication.  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
Note: At setup of the digital output track, tracks to be assigned to  
L and R cannot be the same, for example, such as L-4 and r-4.  
Should setup be executed by mistakenly selecting same track  
numbers for L and R, the number setup for the L channel will be  
given priority and “ -“ (no assign) will be setup automatically for R.  
In other words, L channel will be setup to the specified track and R  
channel will be setup to “-.”  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
4. Press the HOLD/> key, the REWIND button, or the  
F FWD button to select a channel (L or r) and use  
the JOG dial to specify a track.  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting  
obtained prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press the  
STOP button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you press  
one of these keys, the VR800 returns to the previous  
hierarchy level of the menu, and finally exits SETUP  
mode and displays the previous Time Base.  
5. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The selected track assignment is stored, and [?] flashes.  
Setting BAR/BEAT resolution mode (“Resolu ?” menu)  
The “Setting BAR/BEAT resolution mode” menu enables you to turn BAR/BEAT resolution mode on and off.  
The initial setting is “off.” When you turn this mode on, the CLK (clock) digits will be always round off to 00 and  
be stored in the memory key while the VR800 is using the BAR/BEAT/CLK Time Base. That is, beat resolution is  
used. Using this function allows you to automatically store a beat-resolution value of the CLIPBOARD IN/OUT  
points and other points in real-time. (Press the STORE key, then the corresponding memory key while playing the  
VR800.) Therefore, it is very convenient when you perform the Copy & Past or Move & Paste operation in beat-  
resolution.  
For example, assume that you have stored the value for 001BAR1 46 CLK as the CLIPBOARD IN point, and the  
value for 002BAR 4 51 CLK as the CLIPBOARD OUT point.  
These values will be used as they are if BAR/BEAT resolution mode is turned off. However, the mode is turned on, the  
following values will be stored instead. The following example has a time signature setting of 4/4.  
001BAR1 46 CLK -> 001BAR1 00 CLK (A CLK value of 46 will be rounded off.)  
002BAR4 51 CLK -> 003BAR1 00 CLK (A CLK value of 51 will be rounded up.)  
• Initial setting : [o FF]  
• Options  
: [on] or [o FF]  
* This setting is shared by all Programs in the same disk.  
* The settings cannot be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
Setting BAR/BEAT resolution mode  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
flashes  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [ Resolu ?] ([?]  
flashes), then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The current BAR/BEAT resolution mode setting appears  
on the display.  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key turns off the flashing [?]  
character, and the BAR/BEAT resolution mode setting  
flashes. With the initial setting, [o FF] flashes as shown  
below.  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
3. Use the JOG dial to turn the mode [on] or [off].  
When you turn the JOG dial clockwise and counter-  
clockwise, [on] and [o FF] flash alternately.  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting  
obtained prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press  
the STOP button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you  
press one of these keys, the VR800 returns to the  
previous hierarchy level of the menu, and finally exits  
SETUP mode and displays the previous Time Base.  
Selecting [on] turns BAR/BEAT resolution mode on, and  
selecting [o FF] turns BAR/BEAT resolution mode off.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The selected mode setting is stored, and [?] flashes.  
Setting the MIDI device number (“Device ID ?” menu)  
The “Setting the MIDI device number” menu enables you to set the VR800 device ID number required to control  
the unit from a sequence software using MMC (MIDI Machine Control) or FEX (Fostex System Exclusive Message).  
The transmit device ID links to this setting. You can set the device ID from 00 to 99.  
However, if the device ID number of the message the VR800 receives is [7F], the VR800 will recognizes it to  
perform the corresponding operation, regardless of its device ID setting.  
• Initial setting  
• Device ID  
: [00]  
: [00] ~ [99]  
* This setting is shared by all Programs in the same disk.  
* The settings cannot be saved and loaded as part of the song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the power to the unit.  
Setting the MIDI device ID  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
to enter SETUP mode.  
4. Press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
The MIDI device ID number is stored, and [?] flashes.  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [Device ID?] ([?] flashes),  
then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting  
obtained prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press  
the STOP button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you  
press one of these keys, the VR800 returns to the  
previous hierarchy level of the menu, and finally exits  
SETUP mode and displays the previous Time Base.  
The current MIDI device ID number appears on the  
display. Pressing the EXECUTE/YES key turns off the  
flashing [?] character, and the MIDI device ID number  
flashes. With the initial setting, [00] flashes as shown  
below.  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
3. Use the JOG dial to set the desired MIDI device ID  
number.  
Turning the JOG dial clockwise increments the value, and  
turning it counter-clockwise decrements the value.  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (Changing the initial setting: SETUP mode)  
Checking the number of track events (“NOs Event ?” menu)  
The “Checking the number of track events” menu enables you to check the number of events on each track.  
Each track (including Additional tracks) of VR800 Programs consists of consecutive audio files (and “zero” files).  
The number of events represents the total number of audio files and 0 files. Each track can contain up to 512  
events.  
If you are editing a song of typical length (about six minutes), repeated editing operation does not usually cause  
this maximum number to be exceeded. (Exceeding this limit is called “event number overflow.”) Even a 20-  
minute song will not cause event number overflow. This is because the VR800 system always optimizes the data  
structure by keeping the number of events low. However, if a recording on a track is scattered in different areas  
of the disk, or if you have made a very long recording on a single track and performed many edits, you should be  
wary of “event number overflow.” To avoid this problem, use the “Checking the number of track events” menu  
to check the number of events on each track prior to recording or editing.  
Checking the number of track events  
1. While the VR800 is stopped, press the SETUP key  
To cancel the operation, or to restore the setting  
to enter SETUP mode.  
obtained prior to the EXECUTE/YES key press, press  
the STOP button or the EXIT/NO key. Each time you  
2. Turn the JOG dial to select [NOs Event?] ([?]  
press one of these keys, the VR800 returns to the  
flashes), and then press the EXECUTE/YES key.  
previous hierarchy level of the menu, and finally exits  
The screen changes as follows, indicating the number of  
SETUP mode and displays the previous Time Base.  
events on track 1. (In this example, track 1 includes eight  
events.)  
* For more information on audio files and events, refer to  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
the “Audio file and event” section of the ”Before Starting”  
chapter.  
flashes  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
DIGITAL  
44.1kHz  
SETUP  
SYNC OUT  
CLK  
DRIVE  
SCSI  
AUTO  
A.PUNCH  
Indicating the track number.  
Indicating the number of  
selected track events  
3. Use the JOG dial to select another (01-24) to check  
the number of events on the corresponding track.  
4. Press the EXIT/NO key or the STOP button  
repeatedly to exit SETUP mode.  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
(Digital Multitrack Recorder)  
Date:  
MIDI Implementation Chart  
Transmitted  
Version: V1.00  
Model VR800  
Recognized  
Remarks  
Function.....................  
Default  
X
X
X
X
Basic  
Channel  
Changed  
X
X
X
X
X
Default  
Message  
Altered  
Mode  
*******************************  
X
X
Note  
X
True voice  
Number:  
*******************************  
X
X
Note ON  
X
X
Velocity  
Note OFF  
X
X
After  
X
X
Key’s  
Channel’s  
Touch  
Pitch Bend  
X
X
X
X
Control  
Change  
X
X
Program  
X
Change:  
True #  
*******************************  
System Exclusive  
(rem. 1)  
(rem. 2)  
: Quarter frame  
X
X
X
: Song Position  
: Song Select  
: Tune  
Common  
X
X
X
X
: Clock  
System  
: Commands  
Real Time  
(rem. 3)  
: Local ON/OFF  
: All Notes OFF  
: Active Sense  
X
X
X
X
X
X
Aux.  
Message  
X
X
: Reset  
rem. 1: MMC (Device ID=00~99, 127), MTC, Identity reply, FOSTEX Exclusive  
rem. 2: MMC (Device ID=00~99, 127), MTC, Inquiry, FOSTEX Exclusive  
Notes  
rem. 3: START, STOP, CONTINUE  
Mode 1: OMNI ON, POLY  
Mode 3: OMNI OFF, POLY  
Mode 2: OMNI ON, MONO  
Mode 4: OMNI OFF, MONO  
: Yes  
X : No  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
MMC Command List  
Command List  
Movement (Recorder)  
01: STOP  
STOP  
PLAY  
02: PLAY  
03: DEFERRED PLAY  
04: FAST FORWARD  
05: REWIND  
DEFERRED PLAY  
F FWD  
REWIND  
06: RECORD STROBE  
07: RECORD EXIT  
09: PAUSE  
REC  
PUNCH OUT  
STOP  
40: WRITE  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
LOCATE to Setting Data  
CUE/REVIEW (+/- 1~60 times)  
CUE/REVIEW (+/- 1~60 times)  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
41: MASKED WRITE  
42: READ  
44: LOCATE  
46: SEARCH  
47: SHUTTLE  
4C: MOVE  
4D: ADD  
4E: SUBTRACT  
MMC Response/Information Field List  
01: SELECTED TIME CODE  
03: REQUESTED OFFSET  
04: ACTUAL OFFSET  
08: GP 0  
Command  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE  
READ  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ  
09: GP 1  
0A: GP 2  
0B: GP 3  
0C: GP 4  
0D: GP 5  
0E: GP 6  
0F: GP 7  
48: MOTION CONTROL TALLY  
4C: RECORD MODE  
4E: TRACK RECORD STATUS  
4F: TRACK RECORD READY  
51: RECORD MONITOR  
READ/WRITE  
READ  
READ/WRITE/MASKED WRITE  
READ/WRITE  
Inquiry Message List  
IDENTITY REQUEST: F0, 7E, <channel>, 06, 01, F7  
IDENTITY REPLY: F0, 7E, <channel>, 06, 02, 51, 01, 00, 0E, 00, 01, 00, 7F, 7F, F7  
51: Fostex ID  
01, 00: Device family code  
0E, 00: Device family number VR800  
01, 00, 7F, 7F: Software version  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
Fostex MIDI System Exclusive Message Format for VR800  
<Note>  
Following protocol is effective only in equipment which will reply by -  
Identity Reply=F0 7E<channel>06 02 51 01 00 0E 00 01 ** ** ** F7 (VR800)  
against the Inquiry Message=F0 7E<channel>06 01.  
Fostex System Exclusive Message  
General Structure=F0 51<device id><sub id 1>(<data>)F7  
* Numbers are all expressed in hexadecimal units.  
Table: <sub id 1> (<data>)  
Command or Model Set  
Controller to VR800  
Acknowledge or Status  
VR800 to Controller  
Loop on/off  
12 22 (<on/off>)  
Post locate  
Auto rec  
12 28 (<post locate mode>)  
12 2D (<on/off>)  
32 2D (<edit message>)  
Lock enable  
Lock mode  
Copy clip  
12 41 (<lock enable>)  
12 42 (<lock mode>)  
12 45 (<count><mmc track>)  
12 46 (<count=01><repeat count>)  
or  
32 45 (<edit message>)  
32 46 (<edit message>)  
Copy paste  
12 46 (<count><repeat count><mmc track>)  
12 47 (<count><mmc track>)  
12 49  
Erase  
32 47 (<edit message>)  
Clipboard play  
Undo  
32 49 (<edit message><mmc track>)  
32 4A (<edit message>)  
12 4A  
Redo  
12 4B  
32 4B (<edit message>)  
Move clip  
12 4D (<count><mmc track>)  
12 4E (<count=01><repeat count>)  
or  
32 4D (<edit message>)  
Move paste  
32 4E (<edit message>)  
12 4E (<count><repeat count><mmc track>)  
12 4F (<channel><channel>)  
13 3E  
Track exchange  
New program  
Delete program  
Digital in ch.  
Digital out ch.  
Move clip  
32 4F (<edit message>)  
33 3E (<edit message>)  
33 3F (<edit message>)  
13 3F  
13 41 (<channel><channel>)  
13 42 (<channel><channel>) * Refer to Note.  
12 4D (<count><mmc track>)  
13 43 (<program>)  
32 4D (<edit message>)  
Program change  
Click on/off  
13 44 (<on/off>)  
Resolution on/off 13 46 (<on/off>)  
Midi Sync out  
13 47 (<nidi sync>)  
MTC offset mode  
13 48 (<MTC offset mode>)  
13 49 (<count=3><on/off><vari pitch>)  
or  
Vari pitch  
13 49 (<count=1><on/off>)  
14 01 (<signature map>)  
14 02 (<tempo set map>)  
Signature set  
Tempo set  
34 00 (<edit message>)  
34 00 (<edit message>)  
34 00 (<edit message>)  
Tempo map all erase14 03  
Preroll time set  
Frame rate set  
14 04 (<mmc time>)  
14 06 (<frame rate>)  
14 08 (<time base>)  
Time base set  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
Status Request  
Status request command  
Controller to VR800  
Status reply  
VR800 to controller  
Loop op. status  
Loop status  
22 21  
22 22  
22 28  
22 2D  
22 41  
22 42  
22 45  
32 21 (<Loop op. mode = 12>)  
32 22 (<on/off>)  
Post locate status  
Auto rec status  
Lock status  
32 28 (<post locate status>)  
32 2D (<edit message>)  
32 41 (<lock status>)  
Lock mode status  
Copy clip status  
32 42 (<lock mode>)  
32 45 (<edit message=01 or =14>)  
32 46 (<edit message=02><mmc time>)  
or  
Copy paste status 22 46  
32 46 (<edit message=00>)  
32 47 (<edit message=02><mmc time>)  
or  
Erase status  
22 47  
22 4D  
32 47 (edit message=00>)  
32 4D (<edit message=01 or =14>)  
32 4E (<edit message=02><mmc time>)  
or  
Move clip status  
Move paste status 22 4E  
32 4E (<edit message=00>)  
33 41 (<channel><channel>)  
33 41 (<channel=7F><count><mmc track>)  
33 42 (<channel><channel>)  
33 42 (<channel=7F><channel=0>)  
33 43 (<program>)  
Digital in ch. st.  
Adat in status  
Digital out ch. st.  
Adat out status  
Program status  
Click status  
23 41  
23 41  
23 42  
23 42  
23 43  
23 44  
23 45  
23 46  
33 44 (<on/off>)  
Level status  
33 45 (<count=10><level data>)  
33 46 (<on/off>)  
resolution status  
midi sync out status23 47  
MTC offset mode status 23 48  
33 47 (<midi sync>)  
33 48 (<MTC offset mode>)  
33 49 (<count=3><on/off><vari pitch>)  
vari pitch status  
23 49  
signature map req. 24 01(<event number>) 34 01 (<signature map>)  
tempo set map req. 24 02(<event number>) 34 02 (<tempo set map>)  
preroll time req.  
remain time req.  
frame rate status  
time base status  
24 04  
24 05  
24 06  
24 08  
34 04 (<mmc time>)  
34 05 (<mmc time>)  
34 06 (<frame rate>)  
34 08 (<time base>)  
<Note 2>  
There is a limitation on specifying the <channel><channel> setting. For details,  
refer to "Explanation on Command/Mode Set" mentioned in later pages.  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
<Allocation of GP0~GP7>  
Edit point memory of this equipment is alloted to the response/information field  
of 08~0F (GP0~GP7) as shown below.  
GP7 however, will be used as the work memory for small adjusting of the  
registered figure (Refer to Examples 4 and 5).  
<Response/Information Field>  
08 GP0 : locate memory  
09 GP1 : clipboard in memory  
0B GP3 : start memory  
0A GP2 : clipboard out memory  
0C GP4 : auto punch in memory  
0E GP6 : end memory  
0D GP5 : auto punch out memory  
0F GP7 : reserved  
[Example 1] <mmc time> is registered in the start memory (using the write command).  
F0 7F <device ID> 06 <write = 40> <count> <GP3 = 0B> <mmc time> F7  
[Example 2] Locate memory is recalled (using the read command).  
F0 7F <device ID> 06 <read = 42> <count> <GP3 = 08> <mmc time> F7  
[Example 3] On-the-fly registering in the punch in memory (using the move command).  
F0 7F <device ID> 06 <move = 4C> <count> <destination = 0C (GP4) > <source =  
selected time code = 01> F7  
[Example 4] When + 1 frame is to be set in the punch in memory (using the add  
command).  
* Time figure to be added is pre-registered in GP7 (Set 00h 00m 00s 01f in GP7).  
F0 7F <device ID> 06 <add = 4D> <count> <destination = 0C (GP4)> <source #1 = 01  
(GP4)> <source #2 = 0F (GP7)> F7  
[Example 5] When -1 frame is to be set in the punch in memory (using the subtract  
command).  
* Time figure to be subtracted is pre-registered in GP7 (Set 00h 00m 00s 01f in  
GP7).  
F0 7F <device ID> 06 <substract = 4E> <count> <destination = 0C (GP4)>  
<source#1 = 0C (GP4)> <source #2 = 0F (GP7)>F7  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
Data Type  
<loop op.mode>  
12=stop  
Indicates the next operating mode following locating to the start point (GP3) upon arriving  
at the end point (GP6) by the play mode. In VR800, 12=stop only is effective.  
12=stop  
<post locate mode>  
15=play  
Specifies operating mode in which VR800 should enter upon completing the locate  
operation. Corresponds to the setting of AUTO PLAY ON ("15")/OFF ("12") on the main  
unit.  
<count>  
01 ~ 7F  
Specifies succeeding data byte numbers.  
<mmc track>  
<edit message>  
Complies to the MMC (MIDI Machine Control) standard track bit map.  
In VR800, you always need to specify two byte combinations of "r0" and "r1."  
00 = no message  
01 = completed (completion flag)  
02 = active (execution flag)  
02<mmc time> = Indicates unprocessed time by active (execution flag) and <mmc time>.  
02<count><mmc track> = Indicates source track by active (execution flag) and <mmc  
track>. Used for clipboard play.  
03 = cancel (execution stop)  
05 = Indicates rehearsal (rehearsal mode of auto rec). Possible of undo.  
06 = Indicates take (take mode of auto rec). Possible of undo.  
10 = over value error  
10 <mmc time> = Capacity shortage time is indicated by over value error (error by  
capacity shortage) and <mmc time>. In copy paste, it indicates capacity shortage time  
required for a minimum one time paste.  
11 = Indicates in point error (incorrect in point).  
12 = Indicates out point error (incorrect out point).  
14 = Indicates void data (data necessary for paste does not exist).  
18 = Indicates track select error (track necessary to execute copy/move or erase/cut is not  
correctly setup).  
19<repeat count> = Indicates repeat number error and repeat numbers executable by  
<repeat count>.  
1A = Indicates disable rec (record disable mode).  
25 = Indicates can't undo rehearsal (rehearsal mode of auto rec). Impossible to undo.  
26 = Indicates can't undo take (take mode of auto rec). Impossible toundo.  
71 = Indicates on.  
72 = Indicates off.  
<mmc time>  
<on/off>  
hr mn sc fr {ff/st} complies to the MMC standard time code.  
70 = default  
71 = on  
72 = off  
<repeat count>  
<channel>  
01 ~ 7F  
Especially when executing commands such as paste, the number of pasting times to be  
continuously repeated following the auto punch in point is specified.  
00 ~ 08, 7F  
Select recorder tracks 1~8. "00" in particular, is not specified (default setting). "7F"  
indicates input/output of Adat optical. For details, refer to explanation on setting the  
Command/Mode.  
<lock enable>  
<lock status>  
<program>  
00 = lock disable, chase disable  
01 = lock enable, chase enable  
Corresponds to SLAVE ON ("01")/OFF ("00") in the main unit.  
00 = lock disable, chase disable  
01 = lock enable (unlocked), chase enable (unlocked)  
11 = lock enable (locked), chase enable (locked)  
01 ~ 7F  
Indicates program numbers (P1 ~ P99) on the main unit. However, VR800 can specify  
only 01 (corresponds to P01) ~ 63H (corresponds to P99).  
40 = Free  
<lock mode>  
42 = Vari  
Indicates the slave mode when this equipment is set to slave ON.  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
<signature map>  
bar2, bar1, bar0, sign, sigd  
bar2: The 100th digit of the bar figure is expressed in BCD.  
bar1: The 10th digit of the bar figure is expressed in BCD.  
bar0: The 1 digit of the bar figure is expressed in BCD.  
sign: Numerator of the signature to be set is expressed in BCD.  
sigd: Denominator of the signature to be set is expressed in BCD.  
When specified as sign=00 and sigd=00, signature data of that bar position will be  
deleted. Also, bar2=bar1=bar0=sign=sigd=00 indicates "no corresponding data"  
(such as when a figure specified by <event number> do not exist at receiving the  
signature map request).  
<tempo set map>  
bar2, bar1, bar0, beat, tmp2, tmp1, tmp0  
bar2: The 100th digit of the bar figure is expressed in BCD.  
bar1: The 10th digit of the bar figure is expressed in BCD.  
bar0: The 1 digit of the bar figure is expressed in BCD.  
beat: The beat figure is expressed in BCD.  
tmp2: Numerator of the tempo to be set is expressed in BCD.  
tmp1: Denominator of the tempo to be set is expressed in BCD.  
tmp0: The 1 digit of the tempo is expressed in BCD.  
When specified as tmp2=tmp1=tmp0=00, tempo data of that bar and meter position  
will be deleted. Also, bar2=bar1=bar0=sign=sigd=00 indicates "no corresponding  
data" (such as when a figure specified by <event number> do not exist at receiving  
the signature map request).  
<event number>  
<midi sync>  
<vari data>  
When one data registered by <signature map> and <tempo set map> is declared as  
one event, the number of events from head of the tune (the umpteenth event  
counted from head of the tune) must be specified. <event number="00"> is the first  
event.  
00: OFF  
01: CLK (MIDI CLOCK)  
02: MTC  
This corresponds to "MIDI SYNC OUT setting" of the SETUP menu.  
Will be composed of two bytes (Q, P).  
Q: 0qqqqqqq (binary) -> <vari data> = "qqqqqqqppppppp" A 14 bit data of X0.1  
P: 0qqqqqqq (binary)  
attached with a minus symbol.  
Vari-pitch must be specified, at +0.1% when MSB (q)=0 (Example: 0000000000001),  
and at -0.1% when MSB (q)=1 (Example: 1111111111111).  
<frame rate>  
00: 30nd  
01: 25  
02: 24  
03: 30df  
Corresponds to selecting "FRAME RATE setting" of the SETUP menu.  
<MTC offset mode>  
<time base>  
00: ABS  
01: signature  
Corresponds to selecting "MTC OFFSET MODE" of the SETUP menu.  
00: ABS  
01: BAR BEAT  
02: MTC  
Corresponds to selecting "Time Base select ".  
t1, t2 ...... tn  
<level data>  
n: Indicates the track number.  
tn: Indicates absolute 8 bits of the Audio 16 bit data (Range: 00 ~ 7F).  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
12 47 (<count><mmc track>): erase command  
Explanation on the Command/Mode Set  
When this command is received, VR800 will erase the data  
(writes in "0" data) in the section from the pre-registered auto  
punch in point through auto punch out point in the track speci-  
fied by <mmc track>. Since time corresponding to length of  
the erase section is required to complete the erase operation,  
VR800 will immediately reply by "32 47 (<edit message=02  
(active)>)" after receiving the command.  
After the completion of erase operation, "32 47 (<edit mes-  
sage=01 (completed)>)" will be transmitted.  
If erase cannot be executed due to improper figures of the pre-  
registered auto punch in point/auto punch out point, incor-  
rect track section, etc., the corresponding <edit message> will  
be replied.  
12 22 (<on/off>): loop on/off command  
The command for setting the "loop mode on/off" (=ON/OFF of  
AUTO RTN) of VR800. Default figure of the loop operation  
mode is "12=stop" and this cannot be changed.  
12 28 (<post locate mode>): post locate command  
The command for setting the "post locate mode" (=ON/OFF of  
AUTO PLAY) of VR800. It will stop after locating if "post locate  
mode=12." It will enter play after locating if "post locate  
mode=15."  
12 2D (<on/off>): auto rec command  
The command for setting "auto rec mode on/off" (=ON/OFF of  
AUTO PUNCH) of VR800. Upon receiving this command, VR800  
will immediately reply the operating condition by sending "32  
2D (<edit message>)".  
12 49: clipboard play command  
When this command is received, VR800 will playback once  
from the head of the sound data copied in the clipboard by the  
copy clip and move clip commands.  
12 41 (<lock enable>): lock enable command  
The command for setting "slave mode on/off" (setup menu) of  
VR800.  
Immediately after receiving the command, VR800 will reply  
with "32 49 (<edit message=02 (active)><count><mmc track>)."  
The sound data track number is indicated by (mmc track>.  
Upon completion of playback, "32 49 (<edit message=01 (com-  
pleted) is sent and clipboard play is ended. If there is no sound  
data in the clipboard, "32 49 (<edit message=14 (void data)>)"  
will be sent and clipboard play operation will be interrupted.  
12 42 (<lock mode>): lock mode command  
The command for setup of the slave mode (setup menu) when  
this equipment is set to "slave mode on."  
12 45 (<count><mmc track>) : copy clip command  
12 4A: undo command  
When this command is received, VR800 will copy (multiple  
number of tracks can be copied simultaneously) the sound  
data, as data for copy paste, from the pre-registered clipboard-  
in point to the clipboard-out point in the track specified by  
<mmc track>. With completion of copying the data into the  
clipboard, VR800 will immediately reply with "32 45 (<edit  
message=01 (completed)>)". If copy cannot be executed due  
to improper figures of the pre-registered clipboard in/clipboard  
out points or incorrect track section, the corresponding <edit  
message> will be returned.  
Upon receiving this command, VR800 will revert to the condi-  
tion prior to editing copy paste,erase, move paste, cut, redo  
operation. With completion of undo operation, VR800 will  
reply with "32 4A (<edit message=01(completed)>)."  
If VR800 is not possible to undo, "32 4A (<edit message=00  
(no message)>)" will be replied.  
12 4B: redo command  
When this command is received, VR800 will return to the con-  
dition prior to undo operation.  
With completion of redo operation, VR800 will reply with "32  
4B (<edit message=01(completed)>)."  
If VR800 is not possible to redo, "32 4B (<edit message=00 (no  
message)>)" will be replied.  
12 46 (<count=01><repeat count>): copy paste command  
12 46 (<count><repeat count><mmc track>): copy paste com-  
mand  
When this command is received, VR800 will paste the sound  
data which has been copied into the clipboard, on the same  
track from the pre-registered auto punch in point as the start-  
ing point for the number of time specified by <repeat count>.  
However, if the sound data length in the clipboard is less than  
10ms, the specifying the <repeat count> will be limited to  
"01." Also, by specifying <mmc track>, paste can be executed  
on other tracks in mono (in one track units) or stereo units (in  
combinations of tracks 1-2, 3-4, 5-6, 7-8).  
Since time corresponding to length of the copy clipped sound  
data is required to complete the copy paste operation, VR800  
immediately replies with "32 46(<edit message=02 (active)>)"  
after receiving the command.  
12 4D (<count><mmc track>): move clip command  
When this command is received, VR800 will copy (multiple  
tracks can be copied simultaneously) the sound data from the  
pre-registered clipboard in point to the clipboard out point, as  
data for move paste operation. With completion copying the  
data into the clipboard, VR800 will immediately reply with "32  
4D (<edit message=01 (completed)>)." If copy cannot be ex-  
ecuted by the reason of pre-registered improper clipboard in/  
clipboard out point figures or incorrect track section, etc., the  
corresponding <edit message> will be replied.  
12 4E (<count=01><repeat count>): move paste command  
12 4E (<count><repeat count><mmc track>): move paste com-  
Successively upon completing the paste operation, "32 46 (<edit  
message=01(completed)>)" is transmitted.  
mand  
When this command is received, VR800 will paste the sound  
data which have been moveclipped in the clipboard, for the  
number of times specified by <repeat count> on the same track  
from the pre-registered auto punch in point as the starting  
point. At the same time, the move clipped original sound data  
If paste cannot be executed due to improper figures of the pre-  
registered auto punch in point, insufficient disc capacity, no  
sound data in the clipboard, etc., the corresponding <edit mes-  
sage> will be replied.  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
will be erased (data "0" is written in). However, when sound  
data length in the clipboard is less than 10ms, specifying the  
<repeat count> will be limited to "01."  
Also, by specifying the <mmc track>, paste operation can be  
executed on other tracks in mono (one track unit) or stereo  
units (tracks 1-2, 3-4, 5-6, 7-8).  
Since time corresponding to length of the move clipped sound  
data is required to complete the move paste operation, VR800  
will immediately reply with "32 4E (<edit message=02 (ac-  
tive)>)" after receiving the command.  
Following completion of the move paste operation, "32 4E (<edit  
message = 01 (completed)>)" will be sent.  
13 42 (<channel><channel>): digital out ch.select command  
The source channel for digital out is selected.  
Normally, the first <channel> shown will be the SPDIF L chan-  
nel data, and the second <channel> the SPDIF R channel out-  
put. By FDMS-3 (VR800), any channel within "1 ~ 8" can be  
selected. "<channel=00> <channel =00>" indicates the adat  
output.  
13 42 (<channel=7F><channel=0>): Adat out select command  
In a device which can be switched between SPDIF and Adat, if  
the first display is <channel=7F>, then Adat Out can be setup.  
If paste cannot be executed due to improper figures of the  
previously registered auto punch in point, insufficient disc ca-  
pacity, no sound data is in the clipboard, etc., the correspond-  
ing <edit message> will be replied.  
13 43(<program>): program change command  
The command for PROGRAM CHANGE of VR800. The present  
program number can be changed to the figure indicated by  
<program>.  
12 4F (<channel><channel>): track exchange command (Ex-  
13 44 (<on/off>): click on/off command  
clusive command for FDMS-3.)  
The command for setting the metronome on/off of VR800.  
When ON is set, the metronome signal will be fed to the track 8  
output of VR800.  
When the VR800 receives this command, the track can be ex-  
change between the specified <channel><channel>. Especially,  
if the first <channel=00><channel=01>, then exchange by  
grouping will be executed between channel 1-8 and channel  
17-24, and if the next byte <channel=00><channel=02>,  
then the exchange will be between channel 9-16 and channel  
17-24. If it cannot be executed for some reason, an error mes-  
sage will be sent back.  
13 46 (<on/off>): Bar/Beat Resolution ON/OFF command  
The command for ON/OFF of the bar/beat resolution function  
of this equipments' current program.  
13 47 (<midi sync>): Midi Sync Out command  
The setup command for MIDI Sync Out mode of this equip-  
ments' current program.  
13 3E: product new program command (Exclusive command  
for FDMS-3.)  
13 48 (<MTC offset mode>): MTC offset mode command  
The setup command for MTC offset mode of this equipments'  
current program.  
When the VR800 receives this command, a new program is  
compiled and the current program is transferred to the new  
program. As compilation of the new program is comparatively  
short time, it is replied with "33 3E (<edit message=01 (com-  
pleted)>)" immediately upon completion of execution.  
If it cannot be executed for some reason, an error message will  
be sent back.  
13 49 (<count=3> <on/off> <vari data>): Vari pitch command  
13 49 (<count=1> <on/off>): Vari pitch command  
The command for setting this equipments' vari pitch ON/OFF  
and pitch data.  
13 3F: delete current program command (Exclusive command  
Control of ON/OFF only is possible at <count=1> and both ON/  
OFF and pitch data can be set at <count=3>.  
for FDMS-3.)  
When the VR800 receives this command, the current program  
is deleted and succeeding programs moved up and renumberd.  
If the deleted program is the only tune existing in the track, a  
new program will be made automatically.  
As this delete current program is executed in a comparatively  
short time, "33 3F (<edit message=01 (completed)>)" will be  
sent back immediately upon completing the execution.  
If it cannot be executed for some reason, an error message will  
be sent back.  
14 01 (<signature map>): Signature set command  
The command for setting the meter of this equipment. If a new  
data is registered at the bar position where a data exists, the  
former data will be written over. When this command is re-  
ceived, this equipment will reply with "34 01 (<edit message>)."  
Upon completing the registeration, <edit message> will reply  
with "01 (completed)," or with "10 (over value error)" if  
registeration is attempted at a non-existing point or an errone-  
ous figure is used.  
13 41 (<channel><channel>): digital in ch.select command  
The audio signal input from SPDIF digital in to assigned to the  
destination track specified by <channel>. The first <channel>  
shown in the command is the SPDIF L channel input, and the  
second <channel> the R channel input. "<channel=00>" indi-  
cates the adat input.  
14 02 (<tempo set map>): Tempo set command  
The command for tempo set of this equipment. If a new data is  
registered in a bar/meter where data already exists, the former  
data will be written over. When this command is received, this  
equipment will reply with "34 02 (<edit message>)." Upon  
completing the registeration, <edit message> will reply with  
"01 (completed)," or with "10 (over value error)" if registeration  
is attempted at a non-existing point or an erroneous figure is  
used.  
13 41 (<channel=7F><count><mmc track>):Adat in select com-  
mand  
Channel = 7F indicates that it is Adat In. Normally, it will be  
"<count=0>" and all channels will be inputs from Adat In.  
If <count=0><mmc track> is indicates, then only the tracks  
selected will be Adat In inputs.  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
(<edit message=14 (void data)>)."  
14 03 : Tempo map all erase command  
When this command is received, this equipment will erase all  
meter and tempo data in the current program and thus return  
it to the default state (meter=4/4, tempo: =120). Also, when  
this command is received, this equipment will reply with "34  
03 (<edit message>)." Upon completing the registeration, <edit  
message> will reply with "01 (completed)," or with "10 (over  
value error)" if registeration is attempted at a non-existing point  
or an erroneous figure is used.  
22 46: copy paste status request  
The command inquiring execution status of copy paste edit-  
ing. When this command is received, VR800 will reply with  
either "32 46 (<edit message=02><mmc time>)" or "32 46 (<edit  
message=00>)." <mmc time> indicates unprocessed time un-  
til completion.  
22 47: erase status request  
The command inquiring execution status of erase.  
When this command is received, VR800 will reply by either  
"32 47 (<edit message=02><mmc time>)" or "32 47 (<edit  
message=00>)." <mmc time> indicates unprocessed time un-  
til completion.  
14 04 (<mmc time>): Preroll time set command  
The command for setting the current program preroll time at  
the figure indicated by <mmc time>.  
14 06 (<frame rate>): Frame rate set command  
The command for setting the current program frame rate at  
the figure indicated by <frame rate>.  
22 4D: move clip status request  
The command inquiring the clipboard status. If there is a move  
paste data on the clipboard, VR800 will reply with "32 4D (<edit  
message=01>)." If data in the clipboard is for copy paste or  
there is no valid data on it, "32 4D (<edit message=14 (void  
data)>)" will be replied.  
14 08 (<time base>): Time base set command  
The command for setting the current program time base of  
this equipment to that indicated by <time base>.  
The Status Request Command  
22 4E: move paste status request  
The command inquiring the move paste execution status.  
When this command is received, VR800 will reply with "32 4E  
(<edit message=02><mmc time>)" or "32 4E (<edit mes-  
sage=00>)." <mmc time> indicates unprocessed time until  
completion.  
22 21: loop operation status request  
The command inquiring the loop operation mode setup sta-  
tus. VR800 will reply with "32 21 (<loop op.mode=12>)."  
22 22: loop on/off status request  
The command inquiring the loop on/off (=ON/OFF of AUTO  
RETURN) setup status. VR800 will reply with "32 22 (<on/  
off>)."  
23 41: digital in channel status request  
23 41: adat in channel status request  
The command inquiring the digital in channel setup status.  
When this command is received, VR800 will reply with "33 41  
(<channel><channel>)" or "33 41 (<channel=7F><count><mmc  
track>)."  
22 28: post locate status request  
The command inquiring the post locate mode (ON/OFF of AUTO  
PLAY) setup status. VR800 will reply with "32 28 (<post locate  
mode>)".  
23 42: digital out channel status request  
23 42: adat out channel status request  
22 2D: auto rec status request  
The inquiring the digital out channel setup status.  
When this command is received, VR800 will reply with “33 42  
(<channel><channel>)” or “33 42 (<channel=7F><channel=0>).  
The command inquiring the auto rec mode setup status and  
this is replied by "32 2D (<edit message>)." Reply from VR800  
against this status request will be either one of the following:  
<edit message> =05: Possible to undo rehearsal mode.  
=06: Possible to undo take mode.  
23 43: program status request  
The command inquiring the presently operating program num-  
ber. When this command is received, VR800 will reply with  
"33 43 (<program>)."  
=25:Unpossible to undo rehearsal  
mode.  
=26: Unpossible to undo take.  
=72: off  
23 44: click on/off status request  
The command inquiring the metronome on/off status of VR800.  
When this command is received, VR800 will reply with "33 44  
(<on/off>)."  
22 41: lock status request  
The command inquiring the slave on/off setup status and the  
lock status. VR800 will reply with "32 41 (<lock status>)."  
23 45: level status request  
22 42 : lock mode status request  
The command inquiring the present output level data of the  
1~8 tracks. In VR800 as the level data is updated about every  
40msec., inquiry in 40msec. units is effective.  
When this command is received, VR800 will reply with "33 45  
(<count=10><level data>)."  
The command for inquiring the lock mode setup status and  
this is replied with "32 42 <lock mode>."  
22 45: copy clip status request  
The command inquiring the clipboard condition. If there is a  
copy paste data in the clipboard, VR800 will reply with "32 45  
(<edit message=01>)." If data in the clipboard is for move  
paste or there is no valid data in it, it will reply will "32 45  
23 46: resolution status request  
The command for inquiring the resolution on/off setup status.  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
When this command is received, this equipment replies with  
"33 46 <on/off>."  
Explanation on the Status Reply  
32 21 (<loop op.mode>): loop operation mode status repry  
This is the reply against the "22 21" loop operation status re-  
quest command. <loop op.mode=12> is the only status data of  
VR800 and any other setting is not permissible.  
23 47: midi sync out status request  
The command for inquiring on status of the midi sync out  
setup condition. When this command is received, this equip-  
ment replies with "33 47 <midi sync>."  
32 22 (<on/off>): loop on/off status reply  
This is the reply against "22 22" loop on/off status request.  
23 48: MTC offset mode status request  
The command for inquiring the MTC offset mode setup status.  
When this command is received, this equipment replies with  
"33 48 <MTC offset mode>."  
32 28 (<post locate mode>): post locate mode status reply  
This is the reply against "22 28" post locate status request.  
<post locate mode=12 or 15> is the only status data of VR800  
and any other setting is not permissible.  
23 49: vari pitch status request  
The command for inquiring status of vari pitch on/off and vari  
pitch data. When this command is received, this equipment  
replies with "33 49 (<count=3> <on/off> <vari data>)."  
32 2D (<edit message>): auto rec status reply  
This is the reply against the "12 2D" auto rec command or the  
"22 2D" auto rec status request.  
24 01 (<event number>): signature map request  
The command for inquiring the meter setup. Order number  
counting from the leading tune must be specified in the event  
number (The first event is expressed as "event number=00."  
When this command is received, this equipment replies with  
"34 01(<signature map>)."  
32 41 (<lock status>): lock status repry  
This is the reply against the "22 41" lock status request.  
32 42 (<lock mode>): lock mode status reply  
This the reply against the "22 42" lock mode status request.  
24 02 (<event number>): Tempo set map request  
The command for inquiring tempo data. Order number from  
the leading tune must be specified in the event number (The  
first event is expressed as "event number=00."  
When this command is received, this equipment replies with  
"34 02 (<tempo set map>)."  
32 45 (<edit message>): copy clip status reply  
This is the reply against the "12 45" copy clip command or the  
"22 45" copy clip status request.  
32 46 (<edit message>): copy paste status reply  
32 46 (<edit message><mmc time>): copy paste status reply  
This is the reply against the "12 46" copy paste command or  
the "22 46" copy paste status request. <mmc time> indicates  
the unprocessed time until completion of copy paste editing.  
24 04: preroll time status request  
The command for inquiring the preroll time setup status.  
When this command is received, this equipment replies with  
"34 04 (<mmc time>)."  
32 47 (<edit message>): erase status reply  
32 47 (<edit message><mmc time>): erase status reply  
This is the reply against "12 47" erase command or "22 47"  
erase status request.  
24 05: remain time request  
The command for inquiring the disk remaining time which is  
recordable. When this command is received, this equipment  
replies with "34 05 (<mmc time>)."  
32 49 (<edit message><count><mmc track>): clipboard play  
status reply  
24 06: frame rate status request  
This is the reply against the "12 49" clipboard play command.  
If there is no sound data in the clipboard, "32 49"(<edit mes-  
sage=14 (void data)>)" will be replied. <mmc track> indicates  
the sound data track number.  
The command for inquiring the frame rate setup status.  
When this command is received, this equipment replies with  
"34 06 (<frame rate>)."  
24 08: time base status  
32 4A (<edit message>): undo status reply  
The command for inquiring the setup status of the time base  
shown in the display. When this command is received, this  
equipment replies with "3408 (<time base>)."  
This is the reply against the "12 4A" undo command. Either  
<edit message=01 (completed) or <edit message=14 (void  
data)> will be replied.  
32 4B (<edit message>): redo status reply  
This is the reply against the "12 4B" redo command. Either  
<edit message=01 (completed)> or <edit message=14 (void  
data)> will be replied.  
32 4D (<edit message>): move clip status reply  
This is the reply against the "12 4D" move clip command or  
"22 4D" move clip status request.  
32 4E (<edit message>): move paste status reply  
32 4E (<edit message><mmc time>): move paste status reply  
The reply against the "12 4E" move paste command or the "22  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner’s Manual (MIDI Implementation Chart/MMC List)  
4E" move paste status request. <mmc time> indicates the un-  
processed time until completion of move paste editing.  
34 01 (<signature map>): signature map status reply  
This is the reply against "24 01" (<event number>) signature  
map request. The signature map of the event indicated by the  
<event number> is replied. If there is no event specified (Ex-  
ample: Such as when <event number=5> is requested even  
though there is only 5 meters registered), it will be replied with  
all figures at 00 of the <signature map>.  
32 4F (<edit message>): track exchange status reply  
This is the reply against the "12 4F" track exchange command.  
33 3E (<edit message>): product new program status reply  
This is the reply against the "13 3E" product new program  
command.  
34 02 (<tempo set map>): tempo set map status reply  
The reply against "24 02"(<event number>)tempo set map re-  
quest. Tempo set map of the event indicated by the <event  
number> is replied. If there is no event specified (Example:  
Such as when <event number=20> is requested although only  
10 is setup for tempo), it will be replied with all figures at 00 of  
the <signature map>.  
33 41 (<channel> <channel>): digital in channel status reply  
33 41 (<channel=7F> <count> <mmc track>): adat in status  
reply  
This is the reply against the "23 41" digital in ch. st. request.  
The first <channel> indicates the track number assigned to the  
L channel of the digital audio signal (S/P DIF) from the DATA  
IN connector, and the second <channel> the track number as-  
signed to the R channel. If digital in is set to "Adat," the reply  
for the first <channel> will be 7F and then <count> <mmc  
track>, in this order. In the <mmc track>, the track bit map  
which is the Adat input, is expressed by "1" (In this equipment,  
the reply will all be "1", or in other words, all tracks will be  
collectively converted to Adat inputs or analog inputs).  
34 04 (<mmc time>): preroll set map status reply  
This is the reply against "34 04" preroll time status request  
and this is replied with the presently set preroll time.  
34 05 (<mmc time>): remain time reply  
This is the reply against "24 05" remain time request, and is  
replied with the recordable disc remaining time.  
34 06 (<frame rate>): frame rate status reply  
33 42 (<channel> <channel>): digital out channel status reply  
This is the reply against "24 06" frame rate status request, and  
is replied with the presently set frame rate.  
33 42 (<channel=7F> <channel=00>): adat out status reply  
This is the reply against the "23 42" digital out ch. st. request.  
The first <channel> indicates the track number assigned to the  
L channel output of the digital audio signal (S/P DIF) from the  
DATA OUT connector, and the second <channel> the track  
number as signed to the R channel output. If digital out is set  
to "Adat," the reply for the first <channel> will be 7F and that  
for the second <channel> will be 00.  
34 08 (<time base>): time base status reply  
This is the reply against "24 08" time base status request, and  
is replied with the presently set time base (in the display).  
33 43 (<program>): program status reply  
This is the reply against the "23 43" program status request.  
<program> indicates the presently operating program num-  
ber.  
33 44 (<on/off>): click status reply  
This is the reply against the "23 44" click status request.  
It indicates the on/off setting of the metronome function.  
33 45 (<count=10><level data>): level status reply  
This is the reply against the "23 45" level status request and it  
indicates the present track 1-16 output level data.  
In VR800, as level data is updated 40msec., it will be effective if  
inquiry is made in 40msec. units.  
33 46 (<on/off>): bar/beat resolution status reply  
This is the reply against "23 46" bar/beat resolution status  
request.  
33 47 (<midi sync>): midi sync out status reply  
This is the reply against "23 47" midi sync out status request.  
33 48 (<MTC offset mode>): MTC offset mode status reply  
This is the reply against "23 48" MTC offset mode status re-  
quest.  
33 49 (<count=3> <on/off> <vari data>): vari pitch status reply  
This is the reply against "23 49" vari pitch status request and is  
indicating the vari pitch function on/off and the present vari  
pitch setup figure.  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner's Manual (Maintenance/Specifications)  
Maintenance  
Cleaning the exterior  
* For normal cleaning, use a soft dry cloth.  
For stubborn dirt, moisten a cloth in diluted detergent, wring it out firmly, and wipe the dirt off.  
Then polish with a dry cloth. Never use solvents such as alcohol, thinner or benzene, since these will damage the  
printing and finish of the exterior.  
Specifications  
:Master 4ch mode:  
4 real tracks+20 additional tracks  
(44.1kHz/16bit linear)  
Input/Output  
<DATA IN/OUT>  
Connector  
Format  
: Optical (X 2)  
<Save/Load format>  
:ADAC 8ch mode: SCSI  
: (1) IEC 60958 (S/P DIF)  
: (2) Alesis Proprietary Multi  
Channel Optical Interface (Adat  
optical)  
:Master 8ch mode: FDIO-1 (DAT, adat), SCSI  
:Master 4ch mode: SCSI, FDIO-1 (DAT)  
(Either (1) or (2) is selected in the  
Setup mode.)  
<A/D> : 20-bit 64-time, over sampling, Delta-Sigma  
<D/A> : 20-bit 128-time, over sampling, Delta-Sigma  
<Program No.> : maximum 99 tunes  
<MIDI IN/OUT>  
Connector  
Format  
: DIN 5PIN (X 2)  
: MIDI standard  
<Simultaneous playback tracks>  
:8 tracks (Master 8ch/ADAC 8ch mode)  
:4 tracks (Master 4ch mode)  
<SCSI>  
Connector  
Protocol  
:D-sub 25 pin (X1)  
: SCSI-2, unbalanced transmission  
format  
<Vari Pitch>  
: +/-6%  
<Digital In/Out> : 44.1kHz/16bit linear  
Transmission format : Asynchronous transmission  
Units connected  
SCSI-ID  
: Two  
: Automatic recognition  
General  
Dimensions  
: 254 (W) X 100 (H) X 285 (D) mm  
* Including highest protrusion.  
<WORD OUT>  
Connector  
Output level  
Load impedance  
: BNC (X 1)  
: TTL level  
: 75Ω  
Weight  
: approx. 2.0kg  
Power supply : 120VAC 60Hz  
: 230V~ 50/60Hz  
<PUNCH IN/OUT>  
Power consumption : approx. 15W  
Connector  
: ø6mm Phone jack (X 1)  
(An optional FOOT SW Model 8051  
can be connected.)  
* Specifications and appearance are subject to change  
without notice for product improvement.  
Recording/Reproducing  
* "Adat" and the  
Corporation.  
symbol are trademarks of Alesis  
OPTICAL  
<Recording medium>  
:3.5 inch, hard disk (E-IDE type)  
:External SCSI device (SCSI-2, unbalanced  
transmission format)  
* FDMS-3: Fostex Disk Management System-3.  
* FDIO-1 Ver.2: Fostex Data In Out-1 Ver.2  
<Recording format>  
: FDMS-3*  
<Recording mode>  
:ADAC 8ch mode:  
8 real tracks+16 additional tracks  
(44.1kHz/A.D.A.C.)  
:Master 8ch mode:  
8 real tracks+16 additional tracks  
(44.1kHz/16bit linear)  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VR800 Owner's Manual (Maintenance/Specifications)  
Declaration of EC Directive  
This equipment is compatible with the EMC Directive (89/336/EEC) - Directive on approximation of member nation's  
ordinance concerning the electromagnetic compatibility and with the Low Voltage Directive (73/23/EEC) - Directive on  
approximation of member nation's ordinance concerning electric equipment designed to be used within the specified  
voltage range.  
The Affect of Immunity on This Equipment  
The affect of the European Specification EN50082-1 (coexistence of electromagnetic waves - common immunity  
specification) on this equipment are as shown below.  
* In the electrical fast transient/burst requirements, radiate electromagnetic field requirements and static electricity discharging  
environment, this could be affected by generation of noise in some cases.  
FOSTEX DISTRIBUTORS LIST IN EUROPE  
* Including non-EU countries.  
* underlined: contracted distributors (as of Nov, 1997)  
<AUSTRIA>  
<THE NETHERLANDS>  
NAME: IEMKE ROOS AUDIO B. V.  
ADD: Kuiperbergweg 20, 1101 AG Amsterdam, The Netherlands  
TEL: (+31) 20-697-2121, FAX: (+31) 20-697-4201  
NAME: ATEC Audio-u. Videogeraete VertriebsgesmbH.  
ADD: Im Winkel 5, A-2325 Velm, Austria  
TEL: (+43) 2234-74004, FAX: (+43) 2234-74074  
<BELGIUM>  
NAME: EML N. V.  
ADD: Bijvennestraat 1A, B3500 Hasselt, Belgium  
TEL: (+32) 11-232355, FAX: (+32) 11-232172  
<NORWAY>  
NAME: Siv. Ing. Benum A/S  
ADD: P. O. Box 145 Vinderen, 0319 Oslo 3, Norway  
TEL: (+47) 22-139900, FAX: (+47) 22-148259  
<DENMARK>  
NAME: SC Sound ApS  
ADD: Malervej 2, DK-2630 Taastrup, Denmark  
TEL: (+45) 4399-8877, FAX: (+45) 4399-8077  
<PORTUGAL>  
NAME: Caius - Tecnologias Audio e Musica, Lda.  
ADD: Rua de Santa Catarina, 131 4000 Porto, Portugal  
TEL: (+351) 2-2084456/325400, FAX: (+351) 2-314760  
<FINLAND>  
NAME: Noretron Audio  
ADD: Tonttumuorinkuja 4, FIN-02200 Espoo, Finland  
TEL: (+358) 0-5259330, FAX: (+358) 0-52593352  
<SPAIN>  
NAME: Multitracker, S. A.  
ADD: C/Garcilaso No.9, Madrid 28010, Spain  
TEL: (+34) 1-4470700, 1-4470898, FAX: (+34) 1-5930716  
<FRANCE>  
NAME: Musikengro  
ADD: ZAC de Folliouses, B. P. 609, 01706 Les Echets, France  
TEL: (+33) 72 26 27 00, FAX: (+33) 72 26 27 01  
<SWEDEN>  
NAME: TTS Tal & Ton Studioteknik AB  
ADD: Gelbgjutarevagen 4, S-171 48 Solna, Sweden  
TEL: (+46) 8-7340750, FAX: (+46) 8-824476  
<GERMANY>  
<SWITZERLAND>  
NAME: Audio Bauer Pro AG  
ADD: Bernerstrasse-Nord 182, CH-8064 Zurich, Switzerland  
TEL: (+41) 1-4323230, FAX: (+41) 1-4326558  
NAME: Studio sound & Music GmbH  
ADD: Scheppe Gewissegasse 8, D-35039 Marburg, Germany  
TEL: (+49) 6421-12071, FAX: (+49) 6421-15522  
<GREECE>  
NAME: Bon Studio S. A.  
ADD: 6 Zaimi Street, Exarchia, 106.83 Athens, Greece  
TEL: (+30) 1-3809605-8, 3302059, FAX: (+30) 1-3845755  
<UK>  
NAME: SCV London  
ADD: 3A 6-24 Southgate Road, London N1 3JJ, England, UK  
TEL: (+44) 171-923-1892, FAX: (+44) 171-241-3644  
<ICELAND>  
NAME: I. D. elrf. electronic Ltd.  
ADD: ARMULA 38 108 REYKJAVIK, ICELAND  
TEL: (+354) 588 5010, FAX: (+354) 588 5011  
<ITALY>  
NAME: Recoton Italia Srl.  
ADD:V. 1 Maggio, N 18, 40050 Quarto Inferiore, (BO) Italy  
TEL: (+39) 51-768576, FAX: (+39) 51-768336  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
[A]  
[F]  
ACCESS LED.....................................................................8  
F FWD button................................................................11  
Formatting a current drive.........................................28  
Formatting a backup disk............................................30  
Foot switch....................................................................40  
Fade-in preview............................................................59  
Fade-out preview..........................................................59  
Fostex System Exclusive message.............................108  
AUTO RTN/AUTO PLAY key........................................10  
AUTO RTN END key......................................................13  
AUTO RTN START key.................................................13  
AUTO PUNCH IN key....................................................13  
AUTO PUNCH OUT key................................................13  
AC IN connector...........................................................15  
Acc Error message........................................................19  
Additional Track..........................................................23  
Audio File......................................................................25  
A. D. A. C........................................................................27  
ADAC 8ch mode...........................................................27  
Auto punch in/out take...............................................39  
Auto play function.......................................................55  
Auto return function...................................................55  
Auto repeat function...................................................56  
All Clear? message........................................................91  
[H]  
[ I ]  
HOLD/> key..................................................................12  
Input Monitoring..........................................................24  
Illegal FM message........................................................87  
[J]  
[L]  
JOG dial.........................................................................10  
[B]  
[C]  
Load Err message..........................................................19  
Locate point..................................................................48  
Locate number..............................................................48  
Locate function.............................................................54  
Loading song data........................................................75  
Loading data using SCSI drive....................................80  
Length? message...........................................................83  
Loading data using DAT or adat.................................84  
Back up disk....................................................30, 78, 86  
BAR/BEAT resolution setting....................................103  
Contrast adjustment knob............................................9  
Clipboard in key.............................................................9  
Clipboard out key...........................................................9  
Creating a new program..............................................32  
Cuing.........................................................................57  
Copy & Paste.................................................................61  
Clipboard play..............................................................62  
Chase lock.....................................................................74  
Changing the BAR value..............................................91  
[M]  
MIDI OUT jack...............................................................14  
MIDI IN jack...................................................................15  
Master 8ch mode..........................................................27  
Master 4ch mode..........................................................27  
Manual punch in/out..................................................40  
Metronome function....................................................43  
Move & Paste.................................................................61  
MIDI sync......................................................................68  
MTC sync/MIDI machine control...............................70  
MIDI sync signal output setting..........................69, 71  
Metronome setting.......................................................69  
MTC offset time.....................................................71, 74  
MTC offset mode............................................71, 72, 73  
MTC frame rate......................................................71, 73  
MIDI device...................................................................71  
MIDI sync output signal setting..................................95  
MTC frame rate setting................................................96  
MTC offset time setting................................................96  
MIDI device setting....................................................104  
MIDI implementation chart......................................106  
MMC command list....................................................107  
Maintenance...........................................................118  
[D]  
DISP SEL key....................................................................9  
DATA OUT jack.............................................................14  
DATA IN jack.................................................................14  
Display......................................................................16  
Display when the power is turned on........................16  
Deleting a program......................................................34  
Direct digital recording...............................................45  
Direct locate..................................................................54  
Digital-in clock...............................................45, 85, 101  
Digital input track setting...................................46, 101  
Digital output track setting................................47, 102  
[E]  
Exit/No key......................................................................9  
Execute/Yes key..............................................................9  
EDIT key........................................................................10  
Event.....................................................................25, 105  
Editing a program title.................................................35  
Editing and storing data..............................................50  
Editing LOCATE key data.............................................52  
Erase........................................................................61, 64  
Event check.................................................................105  
[O]  
Over! message...............................................................19  
Outline of the save/load function..............................75  
Offset mode setting......................................................97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Track Over message.....................................................19  
Time Base......................................................................20  
Trimming the locate point..........................................60  
Track exchange......................................................61, 66  
Time signature setting..........................................69, 90  
Tempo setting........................................................69, 92  
[P]  
[R]  
[S]  
PLAY button..................................................................11  
POWER switch...............................................................15  
PUNCH IN/OUT jack..............................................15, 40  
Preset display................................................................16  
Protected message........................................................19  
Program Change....................................................22, 33  
Playback Monitoring....................................................24  
Punch In/Out recording..............................................36  
Press LOC: message......................................................52  
Preview function..........................................................59  
Play DAT message........................................................85  
Position of setup menu................................................89  
Preroll time setting.......................................................94  
[U]  
[V]  
[W]  
UNDO/REDO key............................................................9  
Unformat! message......................................................19  
Undo/Redo function................................39, 42, 63, 65  
VARI PITCH key............................................................11  
Void Data message.......................................................19  
Void Out message.........................................................19  
Record track select key..................................................8  
REWIND button............................................................11  
RECORD button............................................................12  
Rec+Yes! message.........................................................19  
Recording Method.......................................................21  
REMAIN...................................................................18, 21  
Real Track.....................................................................23  
Recording Mode...........................................................27  
Re-formatting.........................................................29, 31  
Rehearsing auto punch in/out...................................38  
Review.......................................................................57  
Rec Start message.........................................................83  
Record protect setting...............................................100  
WORD OUT jack............................................................15  
Warning messages........................................................19  
Wrong Disk message....................................................87  
SETUP key........................................................................9  
SCRUB key.....................................................................10  
SHIFT key......................................................................11  
STOP button..................................................................11  
STORE key.....................................................................12  
SCSI connector..............................................................14  
Selecting time base using the DISP SEL key...............17  
Select TRK message...............................................19, 58  
Storing in real-time......................................................49  
Storing LOCATE key.....................................................51  
SHUTTLE function........................................................57  
SCRUB function............................................................58  
Slave mode....................................................................73  
Slave mode....................................................................74  
Slave mode type...........................................................74  
Saving song data...........................................................75  
Saving data using SCSI drive.......................................78  
Saving data using DAT or adat...................................82  
Sign. Chk message........................................................90  
Sign. Edit message........................................................90  
Slave mode setting.......................................................98  
Slave type setting.........................................................99  
Specifications.........................................................118  
[T]  
TIME BASE SEL key.......................................................10  
Time base selected via the TIME BASE SEL key.........17  
The REMAIN display....................................................18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FOSTEX CORPORATION  
3-2-35 Musashino, Akishima-shi, Tokyo 196-0021, Japan  
FOSTEX CORPORATION OF AMERICA  
15431, Blackburn Ave., Norwalk, CA 90650, U. S. A.  
C PRINTED IN JAPAN MAR.1999 8288 429 000 FX  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Earlex Paint Sprayer HV7000A User Manual
Echo Paint Sprayer MS 53BPE User Manual
EdgeStar Beverage Dispenser TWR481 User Manual
Electro Voice Microphone RE1000 User Manual
Extron electronic TV Cables M59 5 BNC 100 User Manual
Ferris Industries Lawn Mower HC32KAV13 User Manual
FMI Indoor Fireplace BV36B User Manual
Garland Convection Oven TE3 4 User Manual
Garmin Marine GPS System 620 User Manual
GE Convection Oven PT970SM User Manual